NUAN-2013.09.30-10K

 
UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
_______________________________
Form 10-K
(Mark One)
 
þ
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
 
For the fiscal year ended September 30, 2013
OR
o
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
 
For the transition period from          to          
Commission file number 001-36056
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
(Exact name of Registrant as Specified in its Charter)
Delaware
 
94-3156479
(State or Other Jurisdiction of
 
(I.R.S. Employer
Incorporation or Organization)
 
Identification No.)
 
 
 
1 Wayside Road
Burlington, Massachusetts
 
01803
(Address of Principal Executive Offices)
 
(Zip Code)
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code:
(781) 565-5000
SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OF THE ACT:
Title of Each Class
 
Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered
Common stock, $0.001 par value
 
NASDAQ Stock Market LLC
Preferred share purchase rights
 
NASDAQ Stock Market LLC
SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(g) OF THE ACT:
None
Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.  Yes þ No o
Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.  Yes o No þ
Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  Yes þ No o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).  Yes þ No o
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of Registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. þ
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
Large accelerated filer þ
Accelerated filer o
Non-accelerated filer o
Smaller reporting company o
 
(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).  Yes o     No þ
The aggregate market value of the outstanding common equity held by non-affiliates of the Registrant as of the last business day of the Registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter was approximately $4.3 billion based upon the last reported sales price on the Nasdaq National Market for such date. For purposes of this disclosure, shares of Common Stock held by officers and directors of the Registrant and by persons who hold more than 5% of the outstanding Common Stock have been excluded because such persons may be deemed to be affiliates. This determination of affiliate status is not necessarily conclusive.
The number of shares of the Registrant’s Common Stock, outstanding as of October 31, 2013, was 314,880,222.
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
Portions of the Registrant’s definitive Proxy Statement to be delivered to stockholders in connection with the Registrant’s 2014 Annual Meeting of Stockholders are incorporated by reference into Part III of this Form 10-K.
 



NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
 
Page
PART I
Item 1.
Item 1A.
Item 1B.
Item 2.
Item 3.
Item 4.
 
PART II
Item 5.
Item 6.
Item 7.
Item 7A.
Item 8.
Item 9.
Item 9A.
Item 9B.
 
PART III
Item 10.
Item 11.
Item 12.
Item 13.
Item 14.
 
PART IV
Item 15.
 
 
 



 
 
 
 
 
 


Table of Contents

PART I

This Annual Report on Form 10-K contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 that involve risks, uncertainties and assumptions that, if they never materialize or if they prove incorrect, could cause our consolidated results to differ materially from those expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. All statements other than statements of historical fact are statements that could be deemed forward-looking, including statements pertaining to: our future revenue, cost of revenue, research and development expense, selling, general and administrative expenses, amortization of intangible assets and gross margin, earnings, cash flows and liquidity; our strategy relating to our segments; the potential of future product releases; our product development plans and investments in research and development; future acquisitions and anticipated benefits from acquisitions; international operations and localized versions of our products; our contractual commitments; our fiscal 2014 revenue and expense expectations and legal proceedings and litigation matters. You can identify these and other forward-looking statements by the use of words such as “may,” “will,” “should,” “expects,” “plans,” “anticipates,” “believes,” “estimates,” “predicts,” “intends,” “potential,” “continue” or the negative of such terms, or other comparable terminology. Forward-looking statements also include the assumptions underlying or relating to any of the foregoing statements. Our actual results could differ materially from those anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of various factors, including those set forth in Item 1A of this Annual Report under the heading “Risk Factors.” All forward-looking statements included in this document are based on information available to us on the date hereof. We will not undertake and specifically decline any obligation to update any forward-looking statements.

Item 1.
Business

Overview
We are a leading provider of voice and language solutions for businesses and consumers around the world. Our solutions are used in healthcare, mobile, consumer, enterprise customer service, and imaging markets. We offer market-leading accuracy in automated speech recognition, capabilities for natural language understanding, dialog management, text-to-speech, domain knowledge and implementation capabilities, built on our significant, long-term investments in research and development. Our solutions are based on our proprietary voice and language platforms and are used every day by millions of people and thousands of businesses for tasks and services such as requesting information from a phone-based self-service solution, dictating medical records, searching the mobile Web by voice, entering a destination into a navigation system, or working with PDF documents. We continue to develop more intuitive and comprehensive speech and natural language solutions that broaden our markets by expanding the types of solutions we offer. We offer our solutions to our customers in a variety of ways, including through products, hosting, professional services and maintenance and support. Our product revenues include embedded original equipment manufacturers ("OEM") royalties, traditional enterprise perpetual licensing, term-based enterprise licensing and consumer sales. Our hosting revenues are primarily generated through on-demand service models, comprised of hosted transaction-based pricing arrangements that typically have multi-year terms. Our hosting, term license and maintenance and support revenues are recurring in nature as our customers use our products on a repeat basis to handle their needs in medical transcription, medical coding and compliance, enterprise customer service and mobile connected services. Our professional services also offer a visible revenue stream, as we have a backlog of assignments that take time to complete. We are seeing several trends in our markets, including (i) the growing adoption of cloud-based, connected services and highly interactive mobile applications, (ii) deeper integration of virtual assistant capabilities and services, and (iii) the continued expansion of our core technology portfolio from speech recognition to natural language understanding, semantic processing, domain-specific reasoning and dialog management capabilities.

We leverage our global professional services organization and our extensive network of partners to design and deploy innovative solutions for businesses and organizations around the globe. We market and sell our products directly through a dedicated sales force, through our e-commerce website and also through a global network of resellers, including system integrators, independent software vendors, value-added resellers, hardware vendors, telecommunications carriers and distributors.

We have built a world-class portfolio of intellectual property, technologies, applications and solutions through both internal development and acquisitions. We have made additional investments in 2013 in protecting our patent portfolio with increased
spending on patent litigation and patent prosecution activities. We expect to continue to pursue opportunities to expand our assets, geographic presence, distribution network and customer base through acquisitions of other businesses and technologies.

We are organized in four segments: Healthcare, Mobile and Consumer, Enterprise, and Imaging. In fiscal 2013, segment revenue as a percentage of total segment revenue for Healthcare, Mobile and Consumer, Enterprise and Imaging was 47%, 24%, 17% and 12%, respectively. In fiscal 2012, segment revenue as a percentage of total segment revenue for Healthcare, Mobile and Consumer, Enterprise and Imaging was 39%, 29%, 19% and 13%, respectively. See Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements for additional information about our reportable segments.


1

Table of Contents

Healthcare
The healthcare industry is under significant pressure to streamline operations, reduce costs and improve patient care. In recent years, healthcare organizations such as hospitals, clinics, medical groups, physicians’ offices and insurance providers have increasingly turned to improving their clinical documentation process from capturing the physician voice to creating documentation through the use of the information to improve the delivery of care, quality measures, coding accuracy and appropriate reimbursement.
We provide a comprehensive set of solutions and services that support the clinical documentation process from capturing the patient encounter with their physician, to improved clinical documentation, coding, revenue cycle management and other functions. Our hosted and on-premise solutions provide platforms to generate and distribute clinical documentation through the use of advanced dictation and transcription features, and allow us to deliver scalable, highly productive medical transcription solutions. Our Clintegrity suite of products offer solutions that leverage captured information with state-of-the-art coding, compliance and record management, which streamlines health information management ("HIM") processes to assist compliance and reimbursement through professional services and time-based licenses. Through Clinical Documentation Improvement ("CDI") programs, computer-assisted coding ("CAC"), and computer-assisted physician documentation ("CAPD") we bridge the gap between physicians and coders. These solutions significantly streamline speed and completeness of documentation so that providers can shorten the time between the patient visit and the payment for that visit. Our solutions should enable future innovation to transform the way healthcare providers document patient care, through improved interface with electronic medical records and extraction of clinical information to support the billing and insurance reimbursement processes. We also offer speech recognition solutions for radiology, cardiology, pathology and related specialties, that help healthcare providers dictate, edit and sign reports without manual transcription.
We utilize a focused, enterprise sales team and professional services organization to address the market and implementation requirements of the healthcare industry. Direct distribution is supplemented by distributors and partnerships with electronic medical records application and other healthcare IT providers including, but not limited to Allscripts, Cerner, Epic, GE, IBM, McKesson and the University of Pittsburgh Medical Center ("UPMC"). In some cases, our healthcare solutions are priced under a traditional software perpetual licensing model. However, certain of our healthcare solutions, in particular our transcription solutions, are also offered on an on-demand model and priced by volume of usage (such as number of lines transcribed). Our Clintegrity product line is sold under a term-licensing model. We continue to experience an increased preference for on-demand and term-license pricing models. Representative customers include Advocate Health Care, Adventist West, Banner Health, Carolinas HealthCare System, Cleveland Clinic, HCA, Kaiser Permanente, Mayo Clinic, NHS, Partners Healthcare System, Sharp Healthcare, Summit Health, Sutter Health, Tenet Healthcare, Trinity Health, Universal Health Services, U.S. Department of Veterans Affairs, UPMC, U.S. Army and WellSpan Health.

Mobile and Consumer
We help consumers use the powerful capabilities of their phones, cars, tablets, desktop and portable computers, personal navigation devices and other consumer electronics by enabling the use of voice commands, text-to-speech and enhanced text input solutions to control and interact with these devices more easily and naturally, and to access the array of content and services available on the Internet. We believe our market opportunity continues to grow as more cloud-connected devices are introduced, increasing the number of systems that can connect to Nuance Cloud Services. The more powerful capabilities of mobile devices require us to supply a broader set of technologies to support the increasing scope and complexity of the solutions. These technologies include cloud-based speech recognition, natural language understanding, dialog management, text-to-speech and advanced keyboard technologies, where the complexity of the technologies allow us to charge a higher price. In addition, we have seen the adoption of these solutions on a broadening scope of devices, such as televisions, set-top boxes, e-book readers, tablet computers, cameras and third-party downloadable applications. Our suite of mobile solutions and connected services provides a platform for our professional services team to design, develop and deploy custom solutions on a variety of mobile devices and other consumer electronics.
Our portfolio of mobile and consumer solutions and services includes an integrated suite of voice control and text-to-speech solutions, dictation applications, predictive text technologies, mobile messaging services and emerging services such as Web search and voicemail-to-text. Our suite of Dragon general purpose desktop and portable computer dictation applications increases productivity by using speech to create documents, streamline repetitive and complex tasks, input data, complete forms and automate manual transcription processes. In particular, we have focused in recent quarters on integrating our Dragon technology and brand initiatives across mobile and consumer markets. Our Dragon desktop software licensing has been impacted by recent trends in PC sales and structural changes in the Windows software distribution channel. We have strategies in place to mitigate this, including expansion into an OEM distribution model and new subscription based license models.

2

Table of Contents

We utilize a focused, enterprise sales team and professional services organization to address market and implementation requirements. We utilize direct distribution, supplemented by partnerships with electronics suppliers and integrators such as Clarion, Harman International and Rovi. Our solutions are used by mobile phone, automotive, personal navigation device, computer, television and other consumer electronics manufacturers and their suppliers, including Audi, BMW, Ford, GM, HTC, Intel, LG Electronics, Mercedes Benz, Nintendo, Nokia, Panasonic, Samsung, T-Mobile, TomTom and Toyota. Telecommunications carriers, web search companies and content providers are increasingly using our mobile search and communication solutions to offer value-added services to their subscribers and customers. Our embedded mobile solutions are sold to automobile and device manufacturers, generally on a royalty model priced per device sold, as well as on a volume of usage model and sometimes on a license model. Although we generally charge a higher price for the broader technology set needed to support the increasing scope and complexity of the latest solutions, at any given level of our technology set, we continue to see pricing pressures from our OEM partners in our mobile handset business. Our connected mobile services are sold through telecommunications carriers, voicemail system providers, smartphone application developers or directly to consumers, and generally priced on a volume of usage model (such as per subscriber or per use). We continue to see an increasing proportion of revenue from on-demand and transactional arrangements as opposed to traditional upfront licensing of our mobile products and solutions. At the end of fiscal 2013, our mobile cloud services powered handsets, cars, televisions and other mobile devices in 38 languages. Representative connected services customers and partners include Cisco, DirecTV, Rogers, Siemens, Telefonica, Telstra, Time Warner Cable, TISA, T-Mobile and Vodafone. In addition, various smartphone application stores include hundreds of applications that utilize our technology, such as our Dragon Mobile Assistant, DragonDictation, DragonGo! and Swype, as well as third party applications including Ask.com, Bon’ App, Coupons.com, Grainger, Grocery iQ, Kraft iFood App, Merriam-Webster, On-Star, PlaySay, Recipes.com, SayHi Translate, Snapguide, Sonico iTranslate, Vocre and Yellow Pages.
Our most recent versions of Dragon NaturallySpeaking for Windows and Dragon Dictate for Mac were introduced in fiscal 2012 and are currently available in eight languages. Our desktop and portable computer dictation solutions are generally sold under a traditional perpetual software license model. We utilize a combination of our global reseller network and direct sales to distribute our desktop and portable computer dictation products. Resellers include retailers such as Amazon, Best Buy and WalMart. Enterprise customers include organizations such as law firms, insurance agencies and government agencies. Representative customers include ATF, Exxon, FBI, IBM, Texas Department of Family Protective Services and Zurich.

Enterprise

To remain competitive, organizations must improve the quality of customer care while reducing costs and ensuring a positive customer experience. Technological innovation, competitive pressures and rapid commoditization have made it increasingly important for organizations to achieve enduring market differentiation and secure customer loyalty. In this environment, organizations need to satisfy the expectations of increasingly savvy and mobile consumers who demand high levels of customer service.
We deliver a portfolio of customer service business intelligence and authentication solutions that are designed to help companies better support, understand and communicate with their customers. Our solutions include the use of technologies such as voice recognition, natural language understanding, text-to-speech, voice biometrics, virtual assistants and analytics to automate caller identification and authorization, call steering, completion of tasks such as updates, purchases and information retrieval, and automated outbound notifications. Our solutions improve the customer experience, increase the use of self-service and enable new revenue opportunities for our customers. In addition, we offer solutions that improve customer care experiences through web sites and direct interaction with thin-client applications on cell phones, enabling customers to very quickly send and retrieve relevant information. Use of our voice and language processing enabled web sites and mobile customer care solutions can dramatically decrease customer care costs, in comparison to calls handled by operators.
We have expanded our cloud-based, multi-channel portfolio, which include our speech recognition, text-to-speech offerings, voice biometrics and natural language technologies as differentiators in the market. We have introduced two new intelligent virtual assistant services, Nina Mobile and Nina Web, expanded our outbound customer engagement services, and implemented voice biometrics in the cloud. We have also expanded our professional services team worldwide, both to support the increased demand of our cloud services and to enhance coverage for on-premise deployments.

We complement our solutions and products with a global professional services organization that supports customers and partners with business and systems consulting project management, user-interface design, voice science, application development and business performance optimization, allowing us to deliver end-to-end speech solutions and system integration for multi-channel automated customer care.
Our solutions are used by a wide variety of enterprises in customer-service intensive sectors, including telecommunications, financial services, travel and entertainment, and government. Our speech solutions are designed to serve our global partners and customers and are available in approximately 80 languages and dialects worldwide. In addition to our own sales and professional

3

Table of Contents

services teams, we often work closely with industry partners, including Avaya, Cisco and Genesys, that integrate our solutions into their hardware and software platforms. Our enterprise solutions offerings include both a traditional software perpetual licensing model and an on-demand model and are priced by volume of usage (such as number of minutes callers use the system or number of calls completed in the system). Representative customers include Bank of America, Barclays, Cigna, Citibank, Comcast, Deutsche Bank, Disney, FedEx, OnStar, PG&E, Telecom Italia, Telefonica, T-Mobile, U.K. HM Revenue & Customs, USAA, US Airways, Verizon and Wells Fargo.

Imaging
The evolution of the Internet, email and other networks has greatly simplified the ability to share electronic documents, resulting in an ever-growing volume of documents to be used and stored. In addition, the proliferation of network and Internet connected multifunction printers has increased the need to efficiently manage printers and enforce printing policies. Our document imaging, print management and PDF solutions reduce the costs associated with paper documents through easy to use scanning, document management and electronic document routing solutions. We offer versions of our products to multifunction printer manufacturers, home offices, small businesses and enterprise customers. In addition, we offer applications that combine network scanning, network print management and PDF creation to quickly enable distribution of documents to users' desktops or to enterprise applications. Our host of services includes software development toolkits for independent software vendors.
Our imaging solutions are generally sold under a traditional perpetual software license model, and some solutions are also offered as a hosted solution. We utilize a combination of our global reseller network and direct sales to distribute our imaging products. We license our software to multifunction printer manufacturers such as Brother, Canon, Dell, HP and Xerox, which bundle our solutions with multi-function devices, digital copiers, printers and scanners, on a royalty model, priced per unit sold. Representative customers include Aflac, Airbus, Amazon, Barclays, Blue Shield, Citibank, EMC, Ernst & Young, Eurostar, Franklin Templeton, HSBC, Intuit, Johnson & Johnson, JP Morgan Chase, Nationwide, Norwegian Tax Authorities, Office Depot, Phillips, PricewaterhouseCoopers, UPS and US Department of Justice.

Research and Development/Intellectual Property

In recent years, we have developed and acquired extensive technology assets, intellectual property and industry expertise in voice, language and imaging that provide us with a competitive advantage in our markets. Our technologies are based on complex algorithms which require extensive amounts of linguistic and image data, acoustic models and recognition techniques. A significant investment in capital and time would be necessary to replicate our current capabilities.

We continue to invest in technologies to maintain our market-leading position and to develop new applications. As of September 30, 2013, our technologies are covered by approximately 3,000 patents and 1,100 patent applications. Our intellectual property, whether purchased or developed internally, is critical to our success and competitive position and, ultimately, to our market value. We rely on a portfolio of patents, copyrights, trademarks, services marks, trade secrets, confidentiality provisions and licensing arrangements to establish and protect our intellectual property and proprietary rights. We incurred research and development expenses of $292.1 million, $225.4 million, and $179.4 million in fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

International Operations
We have principal offices in a number of international locations including: Australia, Belgium, Canada, Germany, Hungary, India, Ireland, Italy, Japan, and the United Kingdom. The responsibilities of our international operations include research and development, healthcare transcription and editing, customer support, sales and marketing and administration. Additionally, we maintain smaller sales, services and support offices throughout the world to support our international customers and to expand international revenue opportunities.

Geographic revenue classification is based on the geographic areas in which our customers are located. For fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011, 72%, 71% and 73% of revenue was generated in the United States and 28%, 29% and 27% of revenue was generated by our international customers, respectively.

Competition
The individual markets in which we compete are highly competitive and are subject to rapid technology changes. There are a number of companies that develop or may develop products that compete in our target markets; however, currently there is no one company that competes with us in all of our product areas. While we expect competition to continue to increase both from existing competitors and new market entrants, we believe that we will compete effectively based on many factors, including:


4

Table of Contents

Specialized Professional Services.  Our superior technology, when coupled with the high quality and domain knowledge of our professional services organization, allows our customers and partners to place a high degree of confidence and trust in our ability to deliver results. We support our customers in designing and building powerful innovative applications that specifically address their needs and requirements.
International Appeal.  The international reach of our products is due to the broad language coverage of our offerings, including our voice and language technology, which provides recognition for approximately 80 languages and dialects and natural-sounding synthesized speech in 151 voices, and supports a broad range of hardware platforms and operating systems. Our imaging technology supports more than 120 languages for Optical Character Recognition and document handling, with up to 20 screen language choices, including Asian languages.
Technological Superiority.  Our voice, language and imaging technologies, applications and solutions are often recognized as the most innovative and proficient products in their respective categories. Our voice and language technology has industry-leading recognition accuracy and provides a natural, voice-enabled interaction with systems, devices and applications. Our imaging technology is viewed as the most accurate in the industry. Technology publications, analyst research and independent benchmarks have consistently indicated that our products rank at or above performance levels of alternative solutions.
Broad Distribution Channels.  Our ability to address the needs of specific markets, such as financial, legal, healthcare and government, and to introduce new products and solutions quickly and effectively is enhanced through our dedicated direct sales force; our extensive global network of resellers, comprising system integrators, independent software vendors, value-added resellers, hardware vendors, telecommunications carriers and distributors; and our e-commerce website (www.nuance.com).

In our segments, we compete with companies such as Adobe, Google, M*Modal, Microsoft and 3M. In addition, a number of smaller companies in both speech and imaging offer services, technologies or products that are competitive with our solutions in some markets. In certain markets, some of our partners such as Avaya, Cisco, Genesys and Intervoice develop and market products and services that might be considered substitutes for our solutions. Current and potential competitors have established, or may establish, cooperative relationships among themselves or with third parties to increase the ability of their technologies to address the needs of our prospective customers.

Some of our competitors or potential competitors, such as Adobe, Google, Microsoft and 3M, have significantly greater financial, technical and marketing resources than we do. These competitors may be able to respond more rapidly than we can to new or emerging technologies or changes in customer requirements. They may also devote greater resources to the development, promotion and sale of their products than we do.

Employees
As of September 30, 2013, we had approximately 12,000 full-time employees in total, including approximately 1,000 in sales and marketing, approximately 2,000 in professional services, approximately 2,000 in research and development, approximately 1,000 in general and administrative and approximately 6,000 that provide transcription and editing services. Approximately 36 percent of our employees are based outside of the United States, the majority of whom provide transcription and editing services and are based in India. Our employees are not represented by any labor union and are not organized under a collective bargaining agreement, and we have never experienced a work stoppage. We believe that our relationships with our employees are generally good.

Company Information
We were incorporated in 1992 as Visioneer, Inc. under the laws of the state of Delaware. In 1999, we changed our name to ScanSoft, Inc. and also changed our ticker symbol to SSFT. In October 2005, we changed our name to Nuance Communications, Inc. and in November 2005 we changed our ticker symbol to NUAN.

Our website is located at www.nuance.com. This Annual Report on Form 10-K, our Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, our Current Reports on Form 8-K, and all amendments to these reports, as well as proxy statements and other information we file with or furnish to the Securities and Exchange Commission, or the SEC, are accessible free of charge on our website. We make these documents available as soon as reasonably practicable after we file them with, or furnish them to, the SEC. Our SEC filings are also available on the SEC’s website at http://www.sec.gov. Alternatively, you may access any document we have filed by visiting the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, D.C. 20549. Information on the operation of the Public Reference Room can be obtained by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. Except as otherwise stated in these documents, the information contained on our website or available by hyperlink from our website is not incorporated by reference into this report or any other documents we file with or furnish to the SEC.

5

Table of Contents


Item 1A.
Risk Factors
You should carefully consider the risks described below when evaluating our company and when deciding whether to invest in our company. The risks and uncertainties described below are not the only ones we face. Additional risks and uncertainties not presently known to us or that we do not currently believe are important to an investor may also harm our business operations. If any of the events, contingencies, circumstances or conditions described in the following risks actually occurs, our business, financial condition or our results of operations could be seriously harmed. If that happens, the trading price of our common stock could decline and you may lose part or all of the value of any of our shares held by you.
Risks Related to Our Business
Our operating results may fluctuate significantly from period to period, and this may cause our stock price to decline.
Our revenue, bookings and operating results have fluctuated in the past and are expected to continue to fluctuate in the future. Given this fluctuation, we believe that quarter to quarter comparisons of revenue, bookings and operating results are not necessarily meaningful or an accurate indicator of our future performance. As a result, our results of operations may not meet the expectations of securities analysts or investors in the future. If this occurs, the price of our stock would likely decline. Factors that contribute to fluctuations in operating results include the following:
slowing sales by our distribution and fulfillment partners to their customers, which may place pressure on these partners to reduce purchases of our products;
volume, timing and fulfillment of customer orders and receipt of royalty reports;
our ability to generate additional revenue from our intellectual property portfolio;
customers delaying their purchasing decisions in anticipation of new versions of our products;
introduction of new products by us or our competitors;
seasonality in purchasing patterns of our customers;
reduction in the prices of our products in response to competition, market conditions or contractual obligations;
returns and allowance charges in excess of accrued amounts;
timing of significant marketing and sales promotions;
impairment charges against goodwill and intangible assets;
delayed realization of synergies resulting from our acquisitions;
write-offs of excess or obsolete inventory and accounts receivable that are not collectible;
increased expenditures incurred pursuing new product or market opportunities;
general economic trends as they affect retail and corporate sales; and
higher than anticipated costs related to fixed-price contracts with our customers.
Due to the foregoing factors, among others, our revenue, bookings and operating results are difficult to forecast. Our expense levels are based in significant part on our expectations of future revenue and we may not be able to reduce our expenses quickly to respond to a shortfall in projected revenue. Therefore, our failure to meet revenue expectations would seriously harm our operating results, financial condition and cash flows.
Our ability to realize the anticipated benefits of our acquisitions will depend on successfully integrating the acquired businesses.
Our prior acquisitions required, and our recently completed acquisitions, continue to require substantial integration and management efforts and we expect future acquisitions to require similar efforts. Acquisitions of this nature involve a number of risks, including:
difficulty in transitioning and integrating the operations and personnel of the acquired businesses;
potential disruption of our ongoing business and distraction of management;
potential difficulty in successfully implementing, upgrading and deploying in a timely and effective manner new operational information systems and upgrades of our finance, accounting and product distribution systems;
difficulty in incorporating acquired technology and rights into our products and technology;

6

Table of Contents

potential difficulties in completing projects associated with in-process research and development;
unanticipated expenses and delays in completing acquired development projects and technology integration;
management of geographically remote business units both in the United States and internationally;
impairment of relationships with partners and customers;
assumption of unknown material liabilities of acquired companies;
accurate projection of revenue and bookings plans of the acquired entity in the due diligence process;
customers delaying purchases of our products pending resolution of product integration between our existing and our newly acquired products;
entering markets or types of businesses in which we have limited experience; and
potential loss of key employees of the acquired business.
As a result of these and other risks, if we are unable to successfully integrate acquired businesses, we may not realize the anticipated benefits from our acquisitions. Any failure to achieve these benefits or failure to successfully integrate acquired businesses and technologies could seriously harm our business.
Charges to earnings as a result of our acquisitions may adversely affect our operating results in the foreseeable future, which could have a material and adverse effect on the market value of our common stock.
Under accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America, we record the market value of our common stock or other form of consideration issued in connection with an acquisition as the cost of acquiring the company or business. We have allocated that cost to the individual assets acquired and liabilities assumed, including various identifiable intangible assets such as acquired technology, acquired trade names and acquired customer relationships based on their respective fair values. Our estimates of fair value are based upon assumptions believed to be reasonable, but which are inherently uncertain. After we complete an acquisition, the following factors could result in material charges and may adversely affect our operating results and cash flows:
costs incurred to combine the operations of businesses we acquire, such as transitional employee expenses and employee retention, redeployment or relocation expenses;
impairment of goodwill or intangible assets;
amortization of intangible assets acquired;
a reduction in the useful lives of intangible asset acquired;
identification of or changes to assumed contingent liabilities, both income tax and non-income tax related after our final determination of the amounts for these contingencies or the conclusion of the measurement period (generally up to one year from the acquisition date), whichever comes first;
charges to our operating results to eliminate certain duplicative pre-merger activities, to restructure our operations or to reduce our cost structure;
charges to our operating results resulting from expenses incurred to effect the acquisition; and
charges to our operating results due to the expensing of certain stock awards assumed in an acquisition.
Intangible assets are generally amortized over a five to fifteen year period. Goodwill and certain intangible assets with indefinite lives, are not subject to amortization but are subject to an impairment analysis, at least annually, which may result in an impairment charge if the carrying value exceeds its implied fair value. As of September 30, 2013, we had identified intangible assets of approximately $1.0 billion, net of accumulated amortization, and goodwill of approximately $3.3 billion. In addition, purchase accounting limits our ability to recognize certain revenue that otherwise would have been recognized by the acquired company as an independent business. As a result, the combined company may delay revenue recognition or recognize less revenue than we and the acquired company would have recognized as independent companies.
We have grown, and may continue to grow, through acquisitions, which could dilute our existing stockholders.
As part of our business strategy, we have in the past acquired, and expect to continue to acquire, other businesses and technologies. In connection with past acquisitions, we issued a substantial number of shares of our common stock as transaction consideration and also incurred significant debt to finance the cash consideration used for our acquisitions. We may continue to

7

Table of Contents

issue equity securities for future acquisitions, which would dilute existing stockholders, perhaps significantly depending on the terms of such acquisitions. We may also incur additional debt in connection with future acquisitions, which, if available at all, may place additional restrictions on our ability to operate our business.  
Our significant debt could adversely affect our financial health and prevent us from fulfilling our obligations under our credit facility and our convertible debentures.
We have a significant amount of debt. As of September 30, 2013, we had a total of $2,472.2 million of gross debt outstanding, $482.2 million in term loans due in August 2019, $1,050.0 million of senior notes due in 2020 and $940.0 million in convertible debentures. Investors may require us to redeem the 2027 Debentures totaling $250.0 million in aggregate principal amount in August 2014, or sooner if the closing sale price of our common stock is more than 120% of the then current conversion price for certain specified periods. If a holder elects to convert, we will be required to pay the principal amount in cash and any amounts payable in excess of the principal amount will be paid in cash or shares of our common stock, at our election. Investors may require us to redeem the 2031 Debentures, totaling $690.0 million in aggregate principal amount in November 2017, or sooner if the closing sale price of our common stock is more than 130% of the then current conversion price for certain specified periods. If a holder elects to convert, we will be required to pay the principal amount in cash and any amounts payable in excess of the principal amount will be paid in cash or shares of our common stock, at our election. We also have a $75.0 million revolving credit line available to us through August 2018. As of September 30, 2013, there were $6.5 million of letters of credit issued, but there were no other outstanding borrowings under the revolving credit line. Our debt level could have important consequences, for example it could:
require us to use a large portion of our cash flow to pay principal and interest on debt, including the convertible debentures and the credit facility, which will reduce the availability of our cash flow to fund working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions, research and development expenditures and other business activities;
restrict us from making strategic acquisitions or exploiting business opportunities;
place us at a competitive disadvantage compared to our competitors that have less debt; and
limit, along with the financial and other restrictive covenants related to our debt, our ability to borrow additional funds, dispose of assets or pay cash dividends.
Our ability to meet our payment and other obligations under our debt instruments depends on our ability to generate significant cash flow in the future. This, to some extent, is subject to general economic, financial, competitive, legislative and regulatory factors as well as other factors that are beyond our control. We cannot assure you that our business will generate cash flow from operations, or that additional capital will be available to us, in an amount sufficient to enable us to meet our payment obligations under the convertible debentures and our other debt and to fund other liquidity needs. If we are not able to generate sufficient cash flow to service our debt obligations, we may need to refinance or restructure our debt, including the convertible debentures, sell assets, reduce or delay capital investments, or seek to raise additional capital. If we are unable to implement one or more of these alternatives, we may not be able to meet our payment obligations under the convertible debentures and our other debt.
In addition, approximately $482.2 million of our debt outstanding as of September 30, 2013 bears interest at variable rates. If market interest rates increase, our debt service requirements will increase, which would adversely affect our results of operations and cash flows.
Our debt agreements contain covenant restrictions that may limit our ability to operate our business.
The agreement governing our senior credit facility contains, and any of our other future debt agreements may contain, covenant restrictions that limit our ability to operate our business, including restrictions on our ability to:
incur additional debt or issue guarantees;
create liens;
make certain investments;
enter into transactions with our affiliates;
sell certain assets;
redeem capital stock or make other restricted payments;
declare or pay dividends or make other distributions to stockholders; and
merge or consolidate with any entity.
Our ability to comply with these covenants is dependent on our future performance, which will be subject to many factors, some of which are beyond our control, including prevailing economic conditions. As a result of these covenants, our ability to

8

Table of Contents

respond to changes in business and economic conditions and to obtain additional financing, if needed, may be significantly restricted, and we may be prevented from engaging in transactions that might otherwise be beneficial to us. In addition, our failure to comply with these covenants could result in a default under our debt agreements, which could permit the holders to accelerate our obligation to repay the debt. If any of our debt is accelerated, we may not have sufficient funds available to repay the accelerated debt.  
We have a history of operating losses, and may incur losses in the future, which may require us to raise additional capital on unfavorable terms.
We reported net loss of $115.2 million in fiscal 2013, and net income of $207.1 million and $38.2 million for the fiscal years 2012 and 2011, respectively, and have a total accumulated deficit of $369.4 million as of September 30, 2013. If we are unable to maintain profitability, the market price for our stock may decline, perhaps substantially. We cannot assure you that our revenue or bookings will grow or that we will maintain profitability in the future. If we do not achieve and maintain profitability, we may be required to raise additional capital to maintain or grow our operations. Additional capital, if available at all, may be highly dilutive to existing investors or contain other unfavorable terms, such as a high interest rate and restrictive covenants.
Voice and language technologies may not continue to garner widespread acceptance, which could limit our ability to grow our voice and language business.
We have invested and expect to continue to invest heavily in the acquisition, development and marketing of voice and language technologies. The market for voice and language technologies is relatively new and rapidly evolving. Our ability to increase revenue and bookings in the future depends in large measure on the continuing acceptance of these technologies in general and our products in particular. The continued development of the market for our current and future voice and language solutions in general, and our solutions in particular, will also depend on:
consumer and business demand for speech-enabled applications;
development by third-party vendors of applications using voice and language technologies; and
continuous improvement in voice and language technology.
Sales of our voice and language products would be harmed if the market for these technologies does not continue to increase or increases slower than we expect, or if we fail to develop new technology faster than our competitors, and consequently, our business could be harmed and we may not achieve a level of profitability necessary to successfully operate our business.
The markets in which we operate are highly competitive and rapidly changing and we may be unable to compete successfully.
There are a number of companies that develop or may develop products that compete in our targeted markets. The individual markets in which we compete are highly competitive, and are rapidly changing. Within voice and language, we compete with AT&T, Google, Microsoft, and other smaller providers. Within healthcare, we compete with 3M, M*Modal and other smaller providers. Within imaging, we compete with ABBYY, Adobe, I.R.I.S. and NewSoft. In voice and language, some of our partners such as Avaya, Cisco, Intervoice and Genesys develop and market products that can be considered substitutes for our solutions. In addition, a number of smaller companies in voice, language and imaging produce technologies or products that are in some markets competitive with our solutions. Current and potential competitors have established, or may establish, cooperative relationships among themselves or with third parties to increase the ability of their technologies to address the needs of our prospective customers.
The competition in these markets could adversely affect our operating results by reducing the volume of the products we license or the prices we can charge. Some of our current or potential competitors, such as 3M, Adobe, Google and Microsoft, have significantly greater financial, technical and marketing resources than we do. These competitors may be able to respond more rapidly than we can to new or emerging technologies or changes in customer requirements. They may also devote greater resources to the development, promotion and sale of their products than we do.
Some of our customers, such as Google and Microsoft, have developed or acquired products or technologies that compete with our products and technologies. These customers may give higher priority to the sale of their competitive products or technologies. To the extent they do so, market acceptance and penetration of our products, and therefore our revenue and bookings, may be adversely affected. Our success will depend substantially upon our ability to enhance our products and technologies and to develop and introduce, on a timely and cost-effective basis, new products and features that meet changing customer requirements and incorporate technological enhancements. If we are unable to develop new products and enhance functionalities or technologies to adapt to these changes, or if we are unable to realize synergies among our acquired products and technologies, our business will suffer.

9

Table of Contents

The failure to successfully maintain the adequacy of our system of internal control over financial reporting could have a material adverse impact on our ability to report our financial results in an accurate and timely manner.
The SEC, as directed by Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, adopted rules requiring public companies to include a report of management on internal control over financial reporting in their annual reports on Form 10-K that contains an assessment by management of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. In addition, our independent registered public accounting firm must attest to and report on the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. Any failure in the effectiveness of our system of internal control over financial reporting could have a material adverse impact on our ability to report our financial statements in an accurate and timely manner, could subject us to regulatory actions, civil or criminal penalties, shareholder litigation, or loss of customer confidence, which could result in an adverse reaction in the financial marketplace due to a loss of investor confidence in the reliability of our financial statements, which ultimately could negatively impact our stock price.
A significant portion of our revenue and bookings are derived, and a significant portion of our research and development activities are based, outside the United States. Our results could be harmed by economic, political, regulatory and other risks associated with these international regions.
Because we operate worldwide, our business is subject to risks associated with doing business internationally. We anticipate that revenue and bookings from international operations could increase in the future. Most of our international revenue and bookings are generated by sales in Europe and Asia. In addition, some of our products are developed and manufactured outside the United States and we have a large number of employees in India that provide transcription services. We also have a large number of employees in Canada, Germany and United Kingdom that provide professional services. A significant portion of the development of our voice and language products is conducted in Canada and Germany, and a significant portion of our imaging research and development is conducted in Hungary. We also have significant research and development resources in Austria, Belgium, Italy, and United Kingdom. Accordingly, our future results could be harmed by a variety of factors associated with international sales and operations, including:
changes in a specific country's or region's economic conditions;
geopolitical turmoil, including terrorism and war;
trade protection measures and import or export licensing requirements imposed by the United States or by other countries;
negative consequences from changes in applicable tax laws;
difficulties in staffing and managing operations in multiple locations in many countries;
difficulties in collecting trade accounts receivable in other countries; and
less effective protection of intellectual property than in the United States.
We are exposed to fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates.
Because we have international subsidiaries and distributors that operate and sell our products outside the United States, we are exposed to the risk of changes in foreign currency exchange rates. In certain circumstances, we have entered into forward exchange contracts to hedge against foreign currency fluctuations. We use these contracts to reduce our risk associated with exchange rate movements, as the gains or losses on these contracts are intended to offset any exchange rate losses or gains on the hedged transaction. We do not engage in foreign currency speculation. With our increased international presence in a number of geographic locations and with international revenue and costs projected to increase, we are exposed to changes in foreign currencies including the euro, British pound, Canadian dollar, Japanese yen, Indian rupee and Hungarian forint. Changes in the value of foreign currencies relative to the value of the U.S. dollar could adversely affect future revenue and operating results.
Tax matters may cause significant variability in our financial results.
Our businesses are subject to income taxation in the U.S., as well as in many tax jurisdictions throughout the world. Tax rates in these jurisdictions may be subject to significant change. Our effective income tax rate can vary significantly between periods due to a number of complex factors including, but not limited to: (i) projected levels of taxable income; (ii) pre-tax income being lower than anticipated in countries with lower statutory rates or higher than anticipated in countries with higher statutory rates; (iii) increases or decreases to valuation allowances recorded against deferred tax assets; (iv) tax audits conducted by various tax authorities; (v) adjustments to income taxes upon finalization of income tax returns; (vi) the ability to claim foreign tax credits; and (vii) the repatriation of non-U.S. earnings for which we have not previously provided for income taxes. If our effective tax rate increases, our operating results and cash flow could be adversely affected.

10

Table of Contents

We are subject to laws and regulations worldwide, changes to which could increase our costs and adversely affect our business.
We are subject to laws and regulations affecting our domestic and international operations in a number of areas. These U.S. and foreign laws and regulations affect various aspects of our business including, but not limited to, areas of labor, advertising, digital content, consumer protection, real estate, billing, e-commerce, promotions, quality of services, telecommunications, mobile communications and media,  intellectual property ownership and infringement, import and export requirements, anti-corruption, foreign exchange controls and cash repatriation restrictions, data privacy requirements, anti-competition, environmental, health and safety.
Compliance with these laws, regulations and similar requirements may be onerous and expensive, and they may be inconsistent from jurisdiction to jurisdiction, further increasing the cost of compliance and doing business. Any such costs, which may rise in the future as a result of changes in these laws and regulations or in their interpretation could individually or in the aggregate make our products and services less attractive to our customers, delay the introduction of new products in one or more regions, or cause us to change or limit our business practices. We have implemented policies and procedures designed to ensure compliance with applicable laws and regulations, but there can be no assurance that our employees, contractors, or agents will not violate such laws and regulations or our policies and procedures.
Impairment of our intangible assets could result in significant charges that would adversely impact our future operating results.
We have significant intangible assets, including goodwill and intangibles with indefinite lives, which are susceptible to valuation adjustments as a result of changes in various factors or conditions. The most significant intangible assets are patents and core technology, completed technology, customer relationships and trademarks. Customer relationships are amortized on an accelerated basis based upon the pattern in which the economic benefits of customer relationships are being utilized. Other identifiable intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. We assess the potential impairment of intangible assets on an annual basis, as well as whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable. Factors that could trigger an impairment of such assets include the following:
significant underperformance relative to historical or projected future operating results;
significant changes in the manner of or use of the acquired assets or the strategy for our overall business;
significant negative industry or economic trends;
significant decline in our stock price for a sustained period;
changes in our organization or management reporting structure that could result in additional reporting units, which may require alternative methods of estimating fair values or greater disaggregation or aggregation in our analysis by reporting unit; and
a decline in our market capitalization below net book value.
Future adverse changes in these or other unforeseeable factors could result in an impairment charge that would impact our results of operations and financial position in the reporting period identified.
Our sales to government clients subject us to risks, including early termination, audits, investigations, sanctions and penalties.
We derive a portion of our revenues and bookings from contracts with the United States government, as well as various state and local governments, and their respective agencies. Government contracts are generally subject to audits and investigations which could identify violations of these agreements. Government contract violations could result in a range of consequences including, but not limited to, contract price adjustments, civil and criminal penalties, contract termination, forfeiture of profit and/or suspension of payment, and suspension or debarment from future government contracts. We could also suffer serious harm to our reputation if we were found to have violated the terms of our government contracts.
We conducted an analysis of our compliance with the terms and conditions of certain contracts with the U.S. General Services Administration (“GSA”). Based upon our analysis, we voluntarily notified GSA of non-compliance with the terms of two contracts. The final resolution of this matter may adversely impact our financial position.
If we are unable to attract and retain key personnel, our business could be harmed.
If any of our key employees were to leave, we could face substantial difficulty in hiring qualified successors and could experience a loss in productivity while any successor obtains the necessary training and experience. Our employment relationships are generally at-will and we have had key employees leave in the past. We cannot assure you that one or more key employees will not leave in the future. We intend to continue to hire additional highly qualified personnel, including software engineers and

11

Table of Contents

operational personnel, but may not be able to attract, assimilate or retain qualified personnel in the future. Any failure to attract, integrate, motivate and retain these employees could harm our business.
Our business is subject to a variety of U.S. and international laws, rules, policies and other obligations regarding data protection.
We are subject to federal, state and international laws relating to the collection, use, retention, disclosure, security and transfer of personally identifiable information. In many cases, these laws apply not only to third-party transactions, but also to transfers of information between the Company and its subsidiaries, and among the Company, its subsidiaries and other parties with which we have relations. Several jurisdictions have passed laws in this area, and other jurisdictions are considering imposing additional restrictions. These laws continue to evolve and may be inconsistent from jurisdiction to jurisdiction. Complying with emerging and changing requirements may cause us to incur substantial costs or require us to change our business practices. Noncompliance could result in penalties or significant legal liability.
Any failure by us, our suppliers or other parties with whom we do business to comply with our privacy policy or with other federal, state or international privacy-related or data protection laws and regulations could result in proceedings against us by governmental entities or others.
Adverse changes in general economic or political conditions in any of the major countries in which we do business could adversely affect our operating results.
Adverse changes in domestic and global economic and political conditions, as well as uncertainty in the global financial markets may negatively affect our financial results. These macroeconomic developments could negatively affect our business, operating results or financial condition in a number of ways which, in turn, could adversely affect our stock price. A prolonged period of economic decline could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition and exacerbate some of the other risk factors described herein. Our customers may defer purchases of our products, licenses, and services in response to tighter credit and negative financial news or reduce their demand for them. Our customers may also not be able to obtain adequate access to credit, which could affect their ability to make timely payments to us or ultimately cause the customer to file for protection from creditors under applicable insolvency or bankruptcy laws. If our customers are not able to make timely payments to us, our accounts receivable could increase. Political instability in any of the major countries in which we do business would also likely harm our business, results of operations and financial condition.  
Current uncertainty in the global financial markets and the global economy may negatively affect our financial results.
Our investment portfolio, which primarily includes investments in money market funds, is generally subject to credit, liquidity, counterparty, market and interest rate risks that may be exacerbated by the recent global financial crisis. If the banking system or the fixed income, credit or equity markets deteriorate or remain volatile, our investment portfolio may be impacted and the values and liquidity of our investments could be adversely affected.
In addition, our operating results and financial condition could be negatively affected if, as a result of economic conditions, either:
the demand for, and prices of, our products, licenses, or services are reduced as a result of actions by our competitors or otherwise; or
our financial counterparties or other contractual counterparties are unable to, or do not, meet their contractual commitments to us.
Security and privacy breaches may damage client relations and inhibit our growth.
The uninterrupted operation of our hosted solutions and the confidentiality and security of third-party information is critical to our business. Any failures in our security and privacy measures or policies could have a material adverse effect on our financial position and results of operations. If we are unable to protect, or our clients perceive that we are unable to protect, the security and privacy of our confidential information, our growth could be materially adversely affected. A security or privacy breach may:
cause our clients to lose confidence in our solutions;
harm our reputation;
expose us to liability; and
increase our expenses from potential remediation costs.
While we believe we use proven applications designed for data security and integrity to process electronic transactions, there can be no assurance that our use of these applications will be sufficient to address changing market conditions or the security and privacy concerns of existing and potential clients.

12

Table of Contents

Interruptions or delays in service from data center hosting facilities could impair the delivery of our service and harm our business.
We currently serve our customers from data center hosting facilities. Any damage to, or failure of, our systems generally could result in interruptions in our service. Interruptions in our service may reduce our revenue, cause us to issue credits or pay penalties, cause customers to terminate their on-demand services and adversely affect our renewal rates and our ability to attract new customers.
Risks Related to Our Intellectual Property and Technology
Unauthorized use of our proprietary technology and intellectual property could adversely affect our business and results of operations.
Our success and competitive position depend in large part on our ability to obtain and maintain intellectual property rights protecting our products and services. We rely on a combination of patents, copyrights, trademarks, service marks, trade secrets, confidentiality provisions and licensing arrangements to establish and protect our intellectual property and proprietary rights. Unauthorized parties may attempt to copy aspects of our products or to obtain, license, sell or otherwise use information that we regard as proprietary. Policing unauthorized use of our products is difficult and we may not be able to protect our technology from unauthorized use. Additionally, our competitors may independently develop technologies that are substantially the same or superior to our technologies and that do not infringe our rights. In these cases, we would be unable to prevent our competitors from selling or licensing these similar or superior technologies. In addition, the laws of some foreign countries do not protect our proprietary rights to the same extent as the laws of the United States. Although the source code for our proprietary software is protected both as a trade secret and as a copyrighted work, litigation may be necessary to enforce our intellectual property rights, to protect our trade secrets, to determine the validity and scope of the proprietary rights of others, or to defend against claims of infringement or invalidity. Litigation, regardless of the outcome, can be very expensive and can divert management efforts.
Third parties have claimed and may claim in the future that we are infringing their intellectual property, and we could be exposed to significant litigation or licensing expenses or be prevented from selling our products if such claims are successful.
From time to time, we are subject to claims that we or our customers may be infringing or contributing to the infringement of the intellectual property rights of others. We may be unaware of intellectual property rights of others that may cover some of our technologies and products. If it appears necessary or desirable, we may seek licenses for these intellectual property rights. However, we may not be able to obtain licenses from some or all claimants, the terms of any offered licenses may not be acceptable to us, and we may not be able to resolve disputes without litigation. Any litigation regarding intellectual property could be costly and time-consuming and could divert the attention of our management and key personnel from our business operations. In the event of a claim of intellectual property infringement, we may be required to enter into costly royalty or license agreements. Third parties claiming intellectual property infringement may be able to obtain injunctive or other equitable relief that could effectively block our ability to develop and sell our products.
We may incur substantial costs enforcing or acquiring intellectual property rights and defending against third-party claims as a result of litigation or other proceedings.
In connection with the enforcement of our own intellectual property rights, the acquisition of third-party intellectual property rights, or disputes relating to the validity or alleged infringement of third-party intellectual property rights, including patent rights, we have been, are currently, and may in the future be, subject to claims, negotiations or complex, protracted litigation. Intellectual property disputes and litigation are typically very costly and can be disruptive to our business operations by diverting the attention and energy of management and key technical personnel. Although we have successfully defended or resolved past litigation and disputes, we may not prevail in any ongoing or future litigation and disputes. In addition, we may incur significant costs in acquiring the necessary third party intellectual property rights for use in our products. Third party intellectual property disputes could subject us to significant liabilities, require us to enter into royalty and licensing arrangements on unfavorable terms, prevent us from manufacturing or licensing certain of our products, cause severe disruptions to our operations or the markets in which we compete, or require us to satisfy indemnification commitments with our customers including contractual provisions under various license arrangements. Any of these could seriously harm our business.
Our software products may have bugs, which could result in delayed or lost revenue and bookings, expensive correction, liability to our customers and claims against us.
Complex software products such as ours may contain errors, defects or bugs. Defects in the solutions or products that we develop and sell to our customers could require expensive corrections and result in delayed or lost revenue and bookings, adverse customer reaction and negative publicity about us or our products and services. Customers who are not satisfied with any of our products may also bring claims against us for damages, which, even if unsuccessful, would likely be time-consuming to defend,

13

Table of Contents

and could result in costly litigation and payment of damages. Such claims could harm our reputation, financial results and competitive position.
Risks Related to our Corporate Structure, Organization and Common Stock
The holdings of our largest stockholder may enable them to influence matters requiring stockholder approval.
As of September 30, 2013, High River Limited Partnership, Hopper Investments LLC, Barberry Corp., Icahn Partners LP, Icahn Partners Master Fund LP, Icahn Partners Master Fund II LP, Icahn Partners Master Fund III LP, Icahn Enterprises G.P. Inc., Icahn Enterprises Holdings L.P., IPH GP LLC, Icahn Capital LP, Icahn Onshore LP, Icahn Offshore LP, and Beckton Corp. (collectively, the “Icahn Group”), beneficially owned approximately 17% of the outstanding shares of our common stock. Brett Icahn and David Schechter of the Icahn Group have been appointed as directors of the Company. Because of its large holdings of our capital stock relative to other stockholders, the Icahn Group has a strong influence over matters requiring approval by our stockholders.
The market price of our common stock has been and may continue to be subject to wide fluctuations, and this may make it difficult for you to resell the common stock when you want or at prices you find attractive.
Our stock price historically has been, and may continue to be, volatile. Various factors contribute to the volatility of our stock price, including, for example, quarterly variations in our financial results, new product introductions by us or our competitors and general economic and market conditions. Sales of a substantial number of shares of our common stock by our largest stockholders, or the perception that such sales could occur, could also contribute to the volatility or our stock price. While we cannot predict the individual effect that these factors may have on the market price of our common stock, these factors, either individually or in the aggregate, could result in significant volatility in our stock price during any given period of time. Moreover, companies that have experienced volatility in the market price of their stock often are subject to securities class action litigation. If we were the subject of such litigation, it could result in substantial costs and divert management's attention and resources.
Compliance with changing regulation of corporate governance and public disclosure may result in additional expenses.
Changing laws, regulations and standards relating to corporate governance and public disclosure, including the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, new regulations promulgated by the Securities and Exchange Commission and the rules of the Nasdaq Marketplace, are resulting in increased general and administrative expenses for companies such as ours. These new or changed laws, regulations and standards are subject to varying interpretations in many cases, and as a result, their application in practice may evolve over time as new guidance is provided by regulatory and governing bodies, which could result in higher costs necessitated by ongoing revisions to disclosure and governance practices. We are committed to maintaining high standards of corporate governance and public disclosure. As a result, we intend to invest resources to comply with evolving laws, regulations and standards, and this investment may result in increased general and administrative expenses and a diversion of management time and attention from revenue-generating activities to compliance activities. If our efforts to comply with new or changed laws, regulations and standards differ from the activities intended by regulatory or governing bodies, our business may be harmed.  
Future sales of our common stock in the public market could adversely affect the trading price of our common stock and our ability to raise funds in new stock offerings.
Future sales of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market, or the perception that such sales could occur, could adversely affect prevailing trading prices of our common stock and could impair our ability to raise capital through future offerings of equity or equity-related securities. In connection with past acquisitions, we issued a substantial number of shares of our common stock as transaction consideration. We may continue to issue equity securities for future acquisitions, which would dilute existing stockholders, perhaps significantly depending on the terms of such acquisitions. No prediction can be made as to the effect, if any, that future sales of shares of common stock, or the availability of shares of common stock for future sale, will have on the trading price of our common stock.
Our business could be negatively affected as a result of the actions of activist stockholders.
Responding to actions by activist stockholders can be costly and time-consuming, disrupting our operations and diverting the attention of management and our employees. Furthermore, any perceived uncertainties as to our future direction could result in the loss of potential business opportunities, and may make it more difficult to attract and retain qualified personnel and business partners.

14

Table of Contents

We have implemented anti-takeover provisions, which could discourage or prevent a takeover, even if an acquisition would be beneficial to our stockholders.
Provisions of our certificate of incorporation, bylaws and Delaware law, as well as other organizational documents could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire us, even if doing so would be beneficial to our stockholders. These provisions include:
authorized “blank check” preferred stock;
prohibiting cumulative voting in the election of directors;
limiting the ability of stockholders to call special meetings of stockholders;
requiring all stockholder actions to be taken at meetings of our stockholders; and
establishing advance notice requirements for nominations of directors and for stockholder proposals.
In addition, on August 19, 2013, we implemented a stockholder rights plan, also called a poison pill, that may have the effect of discouraging or preventing a change of control by, among other things, making it uneconomical for a third party to acquire us without the consent of our Board of Directors.


15

Table of Contents

Item 1B.
Unresolved Staff Comments
None.
Item 2.
Properties
Our corporate headquarters are located in Burlington, Massachusetts. As of September 30, 2013, we leased approximately 1.1 million square feet of building space, primarily in the U.S., and to a lesser extent, in Europe, Canada, Japan and the Asia-Pacific regions. In addition, we own 130,000 square feet of building space located in Melbourne, Florida. We lease research and development, and sales and support offices throughout the United States and maintain leased facilities internationally in countries around the world. Larger leased sites include properties located in Montreal, Quebec, Sunnyvale, California and Bangalore, India.
As of September 30, 2013, we also lease space in specialized data centers in Massachusetts, Texas and smaller facilities around the world.
We believe our existing facilities and equipment, which are used by all operating segments, are in good operating condition and are suitable for the conduct of our business.
Item 3.
Legal Proceedings
Like many companies in the software industry, we have, from time to time, been notified of claims that we may be infringing on, or contributing to the infringement of, the intellectual property rights of others. These claims have been referred to counsel, and they are in various stages of evaluation and negotiation. If it appears necessary or desirable, we may seek licenses for these intellectual property rights. There is no assurance that licenses will be offered by all claimants, that the terms of any offered licenses will be acceptable to us or that in all cases the dispute will be resolved without litigation, which may be time consuming and expensive, and may result in injunctive relief or the payment of damages by us.
Item 4.
Not applicable.

16

Table of Contents

PART II

Item 5.
Market for the Registrant's Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
Market Information
Our common stock is traded on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol “NUAN”. The following table sets forth, for our fiscal quarters indicated, the high and low sales prices of our common stock, in each case as reported on the NASDAQ Global Select Market.
 
Low
 
High
Fiscal 2012:
 

 
 

First quarter
$
19.28

 
$
26.97

Second quarter
24.37

 
31.15

Third quarter
19.33

 
26.85

Fourth quarter
19.58

 
25.89

Fiscal 2013:
 

 
 

First quarter
$
19.99

 
$
25.33

Second quarter
18.00

 
24.85

Third quarter
18.05

 
23.38

Fourth quarter
17.90

 
20.01


Holders
As of October 31, 2013, there were 768 stockholders of record of our common stock.

Dividend Policy
We have never declared or paid any cash dividends on our common stock. We currently expect to retain future earnings, if any, to finance the growth and development of our business and do not anticipate paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable future. Furthermore, the terms of our credit facility place restrictions on our ability to pay dividends, except for stock dividends.

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
The following is a summary of our fourth quarter share repurchases:
Period
 
Total Number of Shares Purchased
 
Average Price Paid per Share
 
Total Number of Shares Purchased as Part of Publicly Announced Program (1)
 
Approximate Dollar Value of Shares that May Yet Be Purchased Under the Program
July 1, 2013 - July 31, 2013
 
3,158,155

 
$
18.85

 
3,158,155

 
$
325,441,738

August 1, 2013 - August 31, 2013
 
522,287

 
$
18.82

 
522,287

 
$
315,612,135

September 1, 2013 - September 30, 2013
 

 
$

 

 
$
315,612,135

Total
 
3,680,442

 
 
 
3,680,442

 
$
315,612,135

(1) On April 30, 2013, we announced a share repurchase program for up to $500 million of our outstanding shares of common stock. The plan has no expiration date.
For the majority of restricted stock units granted to employees, the number of shares issued on the date the restricted stock units vest is net of the minimum statutory income withholding tax requirements that we pay in cash to the applicable taxing authorities on behalf of our employees. We do not consider these transactions to be common stock repurchases.

17

Table of Contents

Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds
On September 6, 2013, Warburg Pincus converted 3,562,238 shares of Series B Preferred Stock into an equivalent number of common shares. The shares were issued in reliance upon an exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, provided by Section 4(2) thereof because the issuance did not involve a public offering.
On August 15, 2013, we issued 934,960 shares of our common stock to International Business Machines Corporation as consideration for a collaboration agreement. The shares were issued in reliance upon an exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, provided by Section 4(2) thereof because the issuance did not involve a public offering.

Item 6.
Selected Consolidated Financial Data

The following selected consolidated financial data is not necessarily indicative of the results of future operations and should be read in conjunction with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K (as adjusted for the retrospective application of FASB ASC 470-20 in 2009).
 
Fiscal Year Ended September 30,
(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Operations:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Total revenues
$
1,855.3

 
$
1,651.5

 
$
1,318.7

 
$
1,118.9

 
$
950.4

Gross profit
1,088.7

 
1,046.6

 
818.9

 
709.6

 
590.8

Income from operations
48.5

 
126.2

 
52.6

 
32.9

 
57.6

Provision (benefit) for income taxes
18.6

 
(141.8
)
 
(8.2
)
 
18.0

 
40.4

Net (loss) income
$
(115.2
)
 
$
207.1

 
$
38.2

 
$
(19.1
)
 
$
(19.4
)
Net (Loss) Income Per Share Data:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
(0.37
)
 
$
0.67

 
$
0.13

 
$
(0.07
)
 
$
(0.08
)
Diluted
$
(0.37
)
 
$
0.65

 
$
0.12

 
$
(0.07
)
 
$
(0.08
)
Weighted average common shares outstanding:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
313.6

 
306.4

 
302.3

 
287.4

 
253.6

Diluted
313.6

 
320.8

 
316.0

 
287.4

 
253.6

Financial Position:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents and marketable securities
$
846.8

 
$
1,129.8

 
$
478.5

 
$
550.0

 
$
527.0

Total assets
5,958.6

 
5,799.0

 
4,095.3

 
3,769.7

 
3,499.5

Long-term debt, net of current portion
2,108.1

 
1,735.8

 
853.0

 
851.0

 
848.9

Total stockholders’ equity
2,638.0

 
2,728.3

 
2,493.4

 
2,297.2

 
2,043.0

Selected Data and Ratios:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Working capital
$
604.3

 
$
736.5

 
$
379.9

 
$
459.2

 
$
376.6

Depreciation of property and equipment
39.8

 
31.7

 
27.6

 
21.6

 
18.7

Amortization of intangible assets
168.8

 
155.5

 
143.3

 
135.6

 
115.4

Gross margin percentage
58.7
%
 
63.4
%
 
62.1
%
 
63.4
%
 
62.2
%

Item 7.
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
The following Management’s Discussion and Analysis is intended to help the reader understand the results of operations and financial condition of our business. Management’s Discussion and Analysis is provided as a supplement to, and should be read in conjunction with, our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.

18

Table of Contents

Trends in Our Business
We are a leading provider of voice and language solutions for businesses and consumers around the world. Our solutions are used in the healthcare, mobile, consumer, enterprise customer service, and imaging markets. We are seeing several trends in our markets, including (i) the growing adoption of cloud-based, connected services and highly interactive mobile applications, (ii) deeper integration of virtual assistant capabilities and services, and (iii) the continued expansion of our core technology portfolio from speech recognition to natural language understanding, semantic processing, domain-specific reasoning and dialog management capabilities.

Healthcare.  Trends in our healthcare business include continuing customer preference for hosted solutions and other time-based licenses, and increasing interest in the use of mobile devices to access healthcare systems and records. We continue to see strong demand for transactions which involve the sale and delivery of both software and non-software related services or products, as well as transactions which involve the sale of multiple solutions, such as both hosted transcription services and Dragon Medical licenses. Although the volume processed in our hosted transcription services has steadily increased due to the expanding customer base, we have experienced some erosion in lines processed when customers adopt electronic medical record (EMR) systems, and when in some cases customers use our licensed Dragon Medical product to support input into the EMR.  We believe an important trend in the healthcare market is the impending change in the coding standard from ICD-9 to ICD-10 which is scheduled to take effect in October 2014. Customers are adopting our solutions under the current coding standard, and we believe the migration to ICD-10 is creating an imperative to increase automation of this important workflow. We are investing to expand our product set to address the various healthcare opportunities, including deeper integration with our clinical documentation solutions, as well as expand our international capabilities, and reduce our time from contract signing to initiation of billable services.

Mobile and Consumer.  Trends in our mobile and consumer segment include device manufacturers requiring custom applications to deliver unique and differentiated products such as virtual assistants, broadening keyboard technologies to take advantage of touch screens, increasing hands-free capabilities on cell phones and automobiles to address the growing concern of distracted driving, and the adoption of our technology on a broadening scope of devices, such as televisions, set-top boxes, e-book readers, tablet computers, cameras and third-party applications. The more powerful capabilities of mobile devices require us to supply a broader set of technologies to support the increasing scope and complexity of the solutions. These technologies include cloud-based speech recognition, natural language understanding, dialog management, text-to-speech and enhanced text input, where the complexity of the technologies allow us to charge a higher price. Within given levels of our technology set, we have seen pricing pressures from our OEM partners in our mobile handset business. We continue to see strong demand for transactions which involve the sale and delivery of both software and non-software related services, as well as products to help customers define, design and implement increasingly robust and complex custom solutions such as virtual assistants. We continue to see an increasing proportion of revenue from on-demand and transactional arrangements as opposed to traditional upfront licensing of our mobile products and solutions. Although this has a negative impact on near-term revenue, we believe this model will build stronger and more predictable revenues over time. We are investing to increase our capabilities and capacity to help device manufacturers build custom applications, to increase the capacity of our data centers, to increase the number, kinds and capacity of network services, to enable developers to access our technology, and to expand both awareness and channels for our direct-to-consumer products.

Enterprise.  Trends in our enterprise business include increasing interest in the use of mobile applications and web sites to access customer care systems and records, voice-based authentication of users, increasing interest in coordinating actions and data across customer care channels, and the ability of a broader set of hardware providers and systems integrators to serve the market. We are investing to expand our product set to address these opportunities, to increase efficiency of our hosted applications, expand our capabilities and capacity to help customers build custom applications, and broaden our relationships with new hardware and systems integrator partners serving the market.

Imaging.  The imaging market is evolving to include more networked solutions, mobile access to networked solutions, and multi-function devices. We expect to expand our traditional packaged software sales with subscription versions. We are investing to improve mobile access to our networked products, expand our distribution channels and embedding relationships, and expand our language coverage.

Confronted by dramatic increases in electronic information, consumers, business personnel and healthcare professionals must use a variety of resources to retrieve information, transcribe patient records, conduct transactions and perform other job-related functions. We believe that the power of our solutions can transform the way people use the Internet, telecommunications systems, electronic medical records, wireless and mobile networks and related corporate infrastructure to conduct business.

19

Table of Contents

Strategy
In fiscal 2014, we will continue to focus on growth by providing market-leading, value-added solutions for our customers and partners through a broad set of technologies, service offerings and channel capabilities. We have increased our focus on operating efficiencies, expense and hiring discipline and acquisition synergies to improve gross margins and operating margins. We intend to pursue growth through the following key elements of our strategy:

Extend Technology Leadership.  Our solutions are recognized as among the best in their respective categories. We intend to leverage our global research and development organization, and our broad portfolio of technologies, applications and intellectual property to foster technological innovation and to maintain customer preference for our solutions. We also intend to invest further in our engineering resources and to seek new technological advancements that further expand the addressable markets for our solutions.
Broaden Expertise in Vertical Markets.  Businesses are increasingly turning to Nuance for comprehensive solutions rather than for a single technology product. We intend to broaden our expertise and capabilities to continue to deliver targeted solutions for a range of industries including mobile device manufacturers, healthcare, telecommunications, financial services and government administration. We also intend to expand our global sales and professional services capabilities to help our customers and partners design, integrate and deploy innovative solutions.
Increase Subscription and Transaction Based Recurring Revenue.  We intend to increase our subscription and transaction based offerings in all of our segments. This will enable us to deliver applications that our customers use, and pay for, on a repeat basis, providing us with the opportunity to enjoy the benefits of recurring revenue streams.
Expand Global Presence.  We intend to further expand our international resources to better serve our global customers and partners and to leverage opportunities in established markets such as Europe, and also emerging markets such as Asia and Latin America. We continue to add regional executives and sales employees across geographic regions to better address demand for voice and language based solutions and services.
Pursue Strategic Acquisitions and Partnerships.  We have selectively pursued strategic acquisitions to expand our technology, solutions and resources, and to complement our organic growth. We have proven experience in integrating businesses and technologies to deliver enhanced value to our customers, partners, employees and shareholders. We intend to continue to pursue acquisitions that enhance our solutions, serve specific vertical markets and strengthen our technology portfolio. We have, however, recently slowed the pace and reduced the size of acquisitions to focus our resources more on driving organic growth. We also have formed key partnerships with other important companies in our markets of interest, and intend to continue to do so in the future where it will enhance the value of our business.

Key Metrics
In evaluating the financial condition and operating performance of our business, management focuses on revenue, net income, gross margins, operating margins and cash flow from operations. A summary of these key financial metrics for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2013, as compared to the fiscal year ended September 30, 2012, is as follows:

Total revenue increased by $203.8 million to 1,855.3 million;
Net income declined by $322.4 million to a loss of $115.2 million;
Gross margins decreased by 4.7 percentage points to 58.7%;
Operating margins decreased by 5.0 percentage points to 2.6%; and
Cash provided by operating activities for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2013 was $395.0 million, a decrease of $78.0 million from the prior fiscal year.

In addition to the above key financial metrics, we also focus on certain operating metrics. A summary of these key operating metrics as of and for the period ended September 30, 2013 is as follows:
Annualized line run-rate in our on-demand healthcare solutions increased 5% to approximately 5.1 billion lines per year. The annualized line run-rate is determined using billed equivalent line counts in a given quarter, multiplied by four; and
Total bookings during fiscal 2013 were $1.92 billion which represent the contract value of transactions closed and recorded in the period as determined at the time of contract signing. For fixed price contracts, the bookings value represents the total contract value. For contracts where revenue is based on transaction volume, the bookings value represents the contract price times the estimated future transaction volume during the contract term, whether or not such transaction volumes are guaranteed under a minimum commitment clause.

20

Table of Contents

Estimated three-year value of on-demand contracts increased 9% to approximately $2.1 billion. We determine this value as of the end of the period reported, by using our best estimate of three years of anticipated future revenue streams under signed on-demand contracts then in place, whether or not they are guaranteed through a minimum commitment clause. Our best estimate is based on estimates used in evaluating the contracts and determining sales compensation, adjusted for changes in estimated launch dates, actual volumes achieved and other factors deemed relevant. For contracts with an expiration date beyond three years, we include only the value expected within three years. For other contracts, we assume renewal consistent with historic renewal rates unless there is a known cancellation. Contracts are generally priced by volume of usage and typically have no or low minimum commitments. Actual revenue could vary from our estimates due to factors such as cancellations, non-renewals or volume fluctuations.

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
Total Revenues
The following tables show total revenues by product type and revenue by geographic location, based on the location of our customers, in dollars and percentage change (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Product and licensing
$
753.7

 
$
740.7

 
$
607.4

 
1.8
%
 
21.9
%
Professional services and hosting
832.4

 
674.0

 
509.1

 
23.5
%
 
32.4
%
Maintenance and support
269.2

 
236.8

 
202.2

 
13.7
%
 
17.1
%
Total Revenues
$
1,855.3

 
$
1,651.5

 
$
1,318.7

 
12.3
%
 
25.2
%
United States
$
1,339.7

 
$
1,175.2

 
$
963.7

 
14.0
%
 
21.9
%
International
515.6

 
476.3

 
355.0

 
8.3
%
 
34.2
%
Total Revenues
$
1,855.3

 
$
1,651.5

 
$
1,318.7

 
12.3
%
 
25.2
%

Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
The geographic split for fiscal 2013 was 72% of total revenue in the United States and 28% internationally, as compared to 71% of total revenue in the United States and 29% internationally for the same period last year. The increase in the proportion of revenue generated domestically was primarily driven by our recent acquisitions in our Healthcare segment, which are primarily located in the United States.

Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011

The geographic split for fiscal 2012 was 71% of total revenue in the United States and 29% internationally, as compared to 73% of total revenue in the United States and 27% internationally for fiscal 2011. The increase in the proportion of revenue generated internationally was primarily due to contributions from our Mobile and Consumer and Imaging segments.

Product and Licensing Revenue
Product and licensing revenue primarily consists of sales and licenses of our technology. The following table shows product and licensing revenue, in dollars and as a percentage of total revenue (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Product and licensing revenue
$
753.7

 
$
740.7

 
$
607.4

 
1.8
%
 
21.9
%
As a percentage of total revenues
40.6
%
 
44.9
%
 
46.1
%
 
 

 
 


Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012

Product and licensing revenue for fiscal 2013 increased $13.0 million, as compared to fiscal 2012. The increase consisted of a $55.0 million increase in Healthcare revenue primarily driven by sales of our Clintegrity solutions from our recent acquisitions. This was offset by a $45.3 million decrease in Mobile and Consumer licensing revenue driven by lower sales of embedded licenses in handset and other consumer electronics resulting from continuing shift toward on-demand and ratable pricing models.

21

Table of Contents

As a percentage of total revenue, product and licensing revenue decreased from 44.9% to 40.6%. This decrease is driven by lower sales of embedded licenses in handset and other consumer electronics in our Mobile and Consumer segment, resulting from a continuing shift toward on-demand and ratable pricing models. In addition, the decrease include the impact of our Healthcare acquisitions in fiscal 2012 and 2013, which have a higher proportion of on-demand hosting revenue. We expect this revenue mix shift to continue in fiscal 2014.
Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Product and licensing revenue for fiscal 2012 increased $133.3 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase consisted of a $74.6 million increase in Mobile and Consumer revenue primarily driven by growth in sales of our embedded solutions. Imaging product and licensing revenue increased $36.1 million, primarily driven by sales of our multi-functional peripheral (“MFP”) products, which included revenue associated with our acquisition of Equitrac in the third quarter of fiscal 2011.

Professional Services and Hosting Revenue
Professional services revenue primarily consists of consulting, implementation and training services for customers. Hosting revenue primarily relates to delivering hosted services, such as medical transcription, automated customer care applications, voice message transcription, and mobile infotainment, search and transcription, over a specified term. The following table shows professional services and hosting revenue, in dollars and as a percentage of total revenue (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Professional services and hosting revenue
$
832.4

 
$
674.0

 
$
509.1

 
23.5
%
 
32.4
%
As a percentage of total revenues
44.9
%
 
40.8
%
 
38.6
%
 
 

 
 


Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
Professional services and hosting revenue for fiscal 2013 increased $158.4 million, as compared to fiscal 2012. The increase consisted of a $135.4 million increase in Healthcare revenue primarily driven by transactional volume growth in our on-demand solutions, of which $126.9 million was due to our acquisitions closed during fiscal 2012 and 2013. Mobile and Consumer revenue increased $25.9 million, including a $19.2 million increase driven by transactional volume growth in our connected mobile services, and an $8.3 million increase in professional services to support the custom design and implementation of next-generation mobile solutions in automobiles, handsets and other consumer electronics.
As a percentage of total revenue, professional services and hosting revenue increased from 40.8% to 44.9%. This increase is driven by our Healthcare acquisitions in fiscal 2012 and 2013, which have a higher proportion of on-demand hosting revenue. The increase also includes the continuing shift toward on-demand and ratable pricing models in our handset and other consumer electronics sales in our Mobile and Consumer segment. We expect this revenue mix shift to continue in fiscal 2014.
Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Professional services and hosting revenue for fiscal 2012 increased $164.9 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase consisted of a $130.6 million increase in Healthcare revenue primarily driven by transactional volume growth in our on-demand solutions, of which $77.4 million was due to our acquisitions closed during fiscal 2011 and 2012. Mobile and Consumer revenue increased $30.9 million, primarily attributable to a $16.0 million increase in professional services to support the implementation of our embedded handset and automotive solutions and a $13.4 million increase driven by transactional volume growth in our connected mobile services.

Maintenance and Support Revenue
Maintenance and support revenue primarily consists of technical support and maintenance services. The following table shows maintenance and support revenue, in dollars and as a percentage of total revenue (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Maintenance and support revenue
$
269.2

 
$
236.8

 
$
202.2

 
13.7
%
 
17.1
%
As a percentage of total revenues
14.5
%
 
14.3
%
 
15.3
%
 
 

 
 



22

Table of Contents

Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
Maintenance and support revenue for fiscal 2013 increased $32.4 million, as compared to fiscal 2012 primarily driven by a $14.8 million increase in Healthcare revenue resulting from growth in sales of our Dragon Medical solutions, a $7.9 million increase in Enterprise, driven by strong maintenance renewals and licenses bookings in prior periods, and a $5.4 million increase in Imaging.
Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Maintenance and support revenue for fiscal 2012 increased $34.6 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase was driven by growth in our product and licensing sales which included a $15.8 million increase in Imaging revenue primarily due to our acquisition of Equitrac, and a $10.2 million increase in Healthcare revenue driven by growth in sales of our Dragon Medical solutions.
COSTS AND EXPENSES

Cost of Product and Licensing Revenue
Cost of product and licensing revenue primarily consists of material and fulfillment costs, manufacturing and operations costs and third-party royalty expenses. The following table shows cost of product and licensing revenue, in dollars and as a percentage of product and licensing revenue (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Cost of product and licensing revenue
$
99.4

 
$
74.8

 
$
65.6

 
32.9
%
 
14.0
%
As a percentage of product and licensing revenue
13.2
%
 
10.1
%
 
10.8
%
 
 
 
 

Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
Cost of product and licensing revenue for fiscal 2013 increased $24.6 million, as compared to fiscal 2012, primarily due to a $23.2 million increase in cost driven by sales of our Clintegrity solutions in our healthcare segment. Gross margin decreased 3.1 percentage points primarily due to a 2.6 percentage point impact from higher costs related to our Clintegrity solutions.
Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Cost of product and licensing revenue for fiscal 2012 increased $9.2 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase was primarily due to a $5.0 million increase in Imaging costs driven by our acquisition of Equitrac. Gross margin increased 0.7 percentage points primarily due to a mix shift toward our Mobile embedded solutions which carry a higher gross margin.

Cost of Professional Services and Hosting Revenue
Cost of professional services and hosting revenue primarily consists of compensation for services personnel, outside consultants and overhead, as well as the hardware, infrastructure and communications fees that support our hosting solutions. The following table shows cost of professional services and hosting revenue, in dollars and as a percentage of professional services and hosting revenue (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Cost of professional services and hosting revenue
$
550.9

 
$
424.7

 
$
341.1

 
29.7
%
 
24.5
%
As a percentage of professional services and hosting revenue
66.2
%
 
63.0
%
 
67.0
%
 
 

 
 


Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012

Cost of professional services and hosting revenue for fiscal 2013 increased $126.2 million, as compared to fiscal 2012. The increase was primarily driven by a $116.3 million increase in Healthcare costs related to growth in our on-demand solutions, including the impact from our acquisitions closed during fiscal 2012 and 2013. Gross margin decreased 3.2 percentage points primarily driven by an increased proportion of revenues coming from our on-demand services, including the impact of our acquisitions, as well as growth in labor costs from our hosting and transcription services.

23

Table of Contents

Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Cost of professional services and hosting revenue for fiscal 2012 increased $83.6 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase was primarily driven by a $73.5 million increase in Healthcare costs related to growth in our on-demand solutions, including the impact from our acquisitions closed during fiscal 2011 and 2012. Gross margin increased 4.0 percentage points primarily due to a mix shift toward our Healthcare on-demand offerings which carry a higher gross margin and expanded margins due to an increase in automation services relating to our connected mobile solutions in our Mobile and Consumer segment.

Cost of Maintenance and Support Revenue
Cost of maintenance and support revenue primarily consists of compensation for product support personnel and overhead. The following table shows cost of maintenance and support revenue, in dollars and as a percentage of maintenance and support revenue (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
 
% Change 2011 vs. 2010
Cost of maintenance and support revenue
$
52.7

 
$
45.3

 
$
38.1

 
16.3
%
 
18.9
%
As a percentage of maintenance and support revenue
19.6
%
 
19.1
%
 
18.8
%
 
 

 
 


Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012

Cost of maintenance and support revenue for fiscal 2013 increased $7.4 million, as compared to fiscal 2012. The increase was primarily due to a $5.5 million increase in costs from our acquisitions in the Healthcare and Imaging segments during the period contributing, in part, to the decrease in gross margin.

Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Cost of maintenance and support revenue for fiscal 2012 increased $7.2 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase was primarily due to a $6.9 million increase in Imaging costs related to the increase revenues from our Imaging MFP products, which included the impact from the Equitrac acquisition in fiscal 2011. Gross margin remained relatively flat during the period.

Research and Development Expense
Research and development expense primarily consists of salaries, benefits and overhead relating to engineering staff as well as third party engineering costs. The following table shows research and development expense, in dollars and as a percentage of total revenue (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Research and development expense
$
292.1

 
$
225.4

 
$
179.4

 
29.6
%
 
25.6
%
As a percentage of total revenues
15.7
%
 
13.6
%
 
13.6
%
 
 

 
 


Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012

Research and development expense for fiscal 2013 increased $66.7 million, as compared to fiscal 2012. The increase was attributable to a $43.6 million increase in compensation expense, driven by headcount growth, including additional headcount from our acquisitions during the period, together with a $5.4 million increase in stock-based compensation expense. We increased investment in research and development expense to fund cloud-based speech systems and natural language understanding advancements. We expect significant investment in research and development to continue in fiscal 2014.

Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Research and development expense for fiscal 2012 increased $46.0 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase was attributable to a $35.8 million increase in compensation expense, driven by headcount growth including additional headcount from our acquisitions during the period, as well as increase in stock-based compensation expense.


24

Table of Contents

Sales and Marketing Expense
Sales and marketing expense includes salaries and benefits, commissions, advertising, direct mail, public relations, tradeshow costs and other costs of marketing programs, travel expenses associated with our sales organization and overhead. The following table shows sales and marketing expense, in dollars and as a percentage of total revenue (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Sales and marketing expense
$
420.2

 
$
369.2

 
$
306.4

 
13.8
%
 
20.5
%
As a percentage of total revenues
22.6
%
 
22.4
%
 
23.2
%
 
 
 
 

Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012

Sales and marketing expense for fiscal 2013 increased $51.0 million, as compared to fiscal 2012. The increase was primarily attributable to a $34.2 million increase in compensation expense, including commission expense, driven primarily by headcount growth, including additional headcount from our acquisitions during the period, together with a $4.2 million increase in stock-based compensation expense. Additionally, marketing and channel program spending increased $6.9 million to drive revenue growth as part of demand generation activities during the holiday season in the first quarter of fiscal 2013.

Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Sales and marketing expense for fiscal 2012 increased $62.8 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase was primarily attributable to a $35.9 million increase in compensation expense, driven primarily by additional headcount due to operational and acquisition growth and increased stock-based compensation expense. Additionally, marketing and channel program spending increased $18.6 million to drive revenue growth as part of demand generation activities.

General and Administrative Expense
General and administrative expense primarily consists of personnel costs for administration, finance, human resources, information systems, facilities and general management, fees for external professional advisers including accountants and attorneys, insurance, and provisions for doubtful accounts. The following table shows general and administrative expense, in dollars and as a percentage of total revenue (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
General and administrative expense
$
176.7

 
$
163.3

 
$
147.6

 
8.2
%
 
10.6
%
As a percentage of total revenues
9.5
%
 
9.9
%
 
11.2
%
 
 
 
 

Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
General and administrative expense for fiscal 2013 increased $13.4 million, as compared to fiscal 2012. The increase was primarily attributable to a $12.9 million increase in compensation expense, driven primarily by headcount growth including additional headcount from our acquisitions during the period. In addition, legal expense increased $11.6 million as a result of increased spending on patent litigation and patent prosecution activities. These increases were offset by a $19.5 million decrease in stock-based compensation due to less expense related to performance-based awards and bonus resulting from lower than expected results in fiscal 2013.
Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
General and administrative expense for fiscal 2012 increased $15.7 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase was primarily attributable to a $26.8 million increase in compensation expense, driven primarily by additional headcount due to organic and acquisition growth and increased stock-based compensation expense, offset by a $11.0 million decrease in legal costs primarily associated with decrease in on-going litigation activities.


25

Table of Contents

Amortization of Intangible Assets
Amortization of acquired patents and core and completed technology are included in cost of revenue and the amortization of acquired customer and contractual relationships, non-compete agreements, acquired trade names and trademarks, and other intangibles are included in operating expenses. Customer relationships are amortized on an accelerated basis based upon the pattern in which the economic benefits of the customer relationships are being realized. Other identifiable intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. Amortization expense was recorded as follows (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Cost of revenue
$
63.6

 
$
60.0

 
$
55.1

 
6.0
%
 
8.9
%
Operating expense
105.3

 
95.4

 
88.2

 
10.4
%
 
8.2
%
Total amortization expense
$
168.9

 
$
155.4

 
$
143.3

 
8.7
%
 
8.4
%
As a percentage of total revenues
9.1
%
 
9.4
%
 
10.9
%
 
 
 
 

Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012

Amortization of intangible assets expense for fiscal 2013 increased $13.5 million, as compared to fiscal 2012. The increase was primarily attributable to the amortization of acquired customer relationships from our business acquisitions during fiscal 2013 and the second half of fiscal 2012.

Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Amortization of intangible assets expense for fiscal 2012 increased $12.1 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase was primarily attributable to the amortization of acquired customer relationships from our business acquisitions during fiscal 2012 and the second half of fiscal 2011.
Based on our balance of amortizable intangible assets as of September 30, 2013, and assuming no impairment or change in useful lives, we expect amortization of intangible assets for fiscal 2014 to be $161.9 million.
Acquisition-Related Costs, Net
Acquisition-related costs include those costs related to business and other acquisitions, including potential acquisitions. These costs consist of (i) transition and integration costs, including retention payments, transitional employee costs and earn-out payments treated as compensation expense, as well as the costs of integration-related services provided by third-parties; (ii) professional service fees, including third-party costs related to the acquisition, and legal and other professional service fees associated with disputes and regulatory matters related to acquired entities; and (iii) adjustments to acquisition-related items that are required to be marked to fair value each reporting period, such as contingent consideration, and other items related to acquisitions for which the measurement period has ended. Acquisition-related costs were recorded as follows (dollars in millions):

Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011

% Change 2013 vs. 2012

% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Transition and integration costs
$
28.3

 
$
9.9

 
$
3.4

 
185.9
 %
 
191.2
 %
Professional service fees
20.4

 
48.4

 
18.0

 
(57.9
)%
 
168.9
 %
Acquisition-related adjustments
(19.0
)
 
0.4

 
0.5

 
(4,850.0
)%
 
(20.0
)%
Total Acquisition-related costs, net
$
29.7

 
$
58.7

 
$
21.9

 
(49.4
)%
 
168.0
 %
As a percentage of total revenue
1.6
%
 
3.6
%
 
1.7
%
 
 
 
 

Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
Acquisition-related costs, net for fiscal 2013 decreased $29.0 million, as compared to fiscal 2012. The decrease in net expense was driven by an income of $19.0 million recognized in fiscal 2013 related to the elimination of contingent liabilities established in the original allocations of purchase price for which the measurement period has ended, following the expiration of the applicable statute of limitations. In addition, professional service fees decreased $28.0 million due to lower post-acquisition legal and regulatory costs associated with acquisitions in fiscal 2013 as compared to fiscal 2012. These decreases were offset by an $18.4 million increase in transition and integration costs attributable to a $12.5 million compensation expense recognized for the contingent earn-out obligation related to our acquisition of JA Thomas, as well as post-acquisition transition costs associated with recently completed acquisitions.

26

Table of Contents

Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Acquisition-related costs, net for fiscal 2012 increased $36.8 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase was primarily driven by an increase in professional fees incurred associated with the post-acquisition legal and regulatory costs associated with recently completed acquisitions. For fiscal 2012, transition and integration costs consisted primarily of the costs associated with transitional employees from our acquisition of Swype.
Restructuring and Other Charges, Net
The following table sets forth the activity relating to the restructuring accruals included in Restructuring and Other Charges, net, in fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011 (dollars in millions):
 
Personnel
Related
 
Facilities
Costs
 
Other
 
Total
Balance at September 30, 2010
$
1.8

 
$
0.3

 
$

 
$
2.1

Restructuring charges, net
9.1

 
1.9

 
12.0

 
23.0

Non-cash adjustments
0.2

 

 
(11.9
)
 
(11.7
)
Cash payments
(6.0
)
 
(1.2
)
 
(0.1
)
 
(7.3
)
Balance at September 30, 2011
5.1

 
1.0

 

 
6.1

Restructuring charges, net
6.7

 
0.4

 
0.4

 
7.5

Cash payments
(10.1
)
 
(1.3
)
 
(0.4
)
 
(11.8
)
Balance at September 30, 2012
1.7

 
0.1



 
1.8

Restructuring charges, net
15.3

 
1.6

 
0.3

 
17.2

Non-cash adjustment
(0.5
)
 

 
(0.3
)
 
(0.8
)
Cash payments
(12.3
)
 
(0.5
)
 

 
(12.8
)
Balance at September 30, 2013
$
4.2

 
$
1.2

 
$

 
$
5.4


For fiscal 2013, we recorded net restructuring charges of $17.2 million, which included a $14.6 million severance charge related to the elimination of approximately 300 personnel across multiple functions. In addition to the restructuring charges, we recorded a net gain of $0.8 million related to the sales of two immaterial product lines, which is included in restructuring and other charges, net in our consolidated statements of operations.

For fiscal 2012, we recorded net restructuring and other charges of $7.5 million, which included a $6.7 million severance charge related to the elimination of approximately 160 personnel across multiple functions primarily to eliminate duplicative positions as a result of businesses acquired.

For fiscal 2011, we recorded net restructuring and other charges of $23.0 million, which consisted primarily of an $11.7 million impairment charge related to our Dictaphone trade name resulting from a change in our Healthcare marketing strategy under which we plan to consolidate our brands and will no longer be using the Dictaphone trade name in our new product offerings. In addition, we recorded a $9.1 million charge related to the elimination of approximately 200 personnel across multiple functions primarily to eliminate duplicative positions as a result of businesses acquired during the year and a $1.9 million charge related to the elimination or consolidation of excess facilities.

Other (Expense) Income
Other (expense) income consists of interest income, interest expense, gain (loss) from security price guarantee derivatives, gain (loss) from foreign exchange, and gains (losses) from other non-operating activities. The following table shows other (expense) income in dollars and as a percentage of total revenue (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Interest income
$
1.6

 
$
2.2

 
$
3.2

 
(27.3
)%
 
(31.3
)%
Interest expense
(137.8
)
 
(85.3
)
 
(36.7
)
 
61.5
 %
 
132.4
 %
Other (expense) income, net
(9.0
)
 
22.2

 
11.0

 
(140.5
)%
 
101.8
 %
Total other expense, net
$
(145.2
)
 
$
(60.9
)
 
$
(22.5
)
 
 

 
 

As a percentage of total revenue
7.8
%
 
3.7
%
 
1.7
%
 
 

 
 


27

Table of Contents


Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
Interest expense for fiscal 2013 increased $52.5 million, as compared to fiscal 2012. The increase in interest expense was due to the issuance of $700.0 million of Senior Notes in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2012, as well as an additional $350.0 million of Senior Notes issued in the first quarter of fiscal 2013. Other (expense) income, net decreased $31.2 million from income of $22.2 million in fiscal 2012 to an expense of $9.0 million in fiscal 2013. This decrease included the impact of the fair value adjustments on our security price guarantees, which resulted in a gain of $8.0 million in fiscal 2012, as compared to a loss of $6.6 million in fiscal 2013, driven by our decreasing stock price in fiscal 2013. Also included in Other (expense) income, net in fiscal 2012 was a $13.7 million gain recognized on the original non-controlling equity interest in Vlingo upon the completion of the Vlingo acquisition.
Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Interest expense for fiscal 2012 increased $48.6 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase in interest expense was due to the issuance of $690 million of 2.75% Convertible Debentures due in 2031 in the first quarter of fiscal 2012 and $700 million of 5.375% Senior Notes due in 2020 in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2012. This increased cash interest expense by $22.7 million and non-cash interest by $21.8 million.
Other income, net for fiscal 2012 increased $11.2 million, as compared to fiscal 2011. The increase was primarily driven by a $13.7 million gain recognized on the original non-controlling equity interest in Vlingo upon our acquisition of Vlingo during the third quarter of fiscal 2012.
Provision (Benefit) for Income Taxes
The following table shows the (benefit) provision for income taxes and the effective income tax rate (dollars in millions):
 
Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Provision (benefit) for income taxes
$
18.6

 
$
(141.8
)
 
$
(8.2
)
 
(113.1
)%
 
1,629.3
%
Effective income tax rate
(19.2
)%
 
(217.2
)%
 
(27.4
)%
 
 

 
 


Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
Our effective income tax rate was approximately (19.2)% in fiscal 2013, compared to approximately (217.2%) in fiscal 2012. Provision for income taxes increased $160.4 million in fiscal 2013 as compared to fiscal 2012. In fiscal 2012, we recorded a release of valuation allowance totaling $145.6 million as a result of tax benefits recorded in connection with our acquisitions during the period for which a net deferred tax liability was established in purchase accounting as well as a release of valuation allowance for which it was more likely than not that certain deferred tax assets were realizable. In fiscal 2013, no comparable benefit was recognized. During the third quarter of fiscal 2013, we determined that we had new negative evidence related to our domestic deferred tax asset recoverability assessment. This new evidence, resulting from two consecutive quarterly reductions in our earnings forecast during fiscal 2013, primarily due to the continuing shift toward on-demand and ratable product offerings and revenue streams, led us to establish a valuation allowance against our net domestic deferred tax assets. This valuation allowance was offset by the tax benefits from our current year domestic losses and credits. We also recorded a $10.4 million tax provision representing the establishment of the valuation allowance related to our net domestic deferred tax assets at the beginning of the year.
The effective income tax rate was also impacted by our foreign operations which are subject to a significantly lower tax rate than the U.S. statutory tax rate. This rate differential is driven by our subsidiaries in Ireland. In fiscal 2013, this lower foreign tax rate differential was offset by the impact of the transfer of intangible property between certain of our foreign subsidiaries with significantly different local statutory tax rates. Although the transfer of intangible property between consolidated entities did not result in any gain in the consolidated results of operations, we generated a taxable gain in certain jurisdictions. The future tax deductions associated with the amortization of the transferred intangibles will be generated in a jurisdiction that will not generate an offsetting tax benefit in future periods. (See Note 19 of our Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements).
Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Our effective income tax rate was (217.2)% and (27.4)% for fiscal 2012 and 2011, respectively. Benefit from income taxes increased $133.6 million from $8.2 million in fiscal 2011 to $141.8 million in fiscal 2012. The increase in benefit from income taxes included the release of our valuation allowance resulting from our acquisitions during fiscal 2012 and the recognition of certain deferred tax assets. During fiscal 2012, we recorded a release of valuation allowance of $75.1 million as a result of tax benefits recorded in connection with our acquisitions during the period for which a net deferred tax liability was established in

28

Table of Contents

purchase accounting. In addition, by the end of fiscal 2012, we made a determination that it is more likely than not that certain of our deferred tax assets, primarily in the U.S., will be realized which resulted in a release of $70.5 million of our valuation allowance.

Our effective income tax rate is influenced by the level and mix of earnings and losses by taxing jurisdiction in combination with the applicable differences between U.S. and foreign tax rates. Accordingly, changes in the jurisdictional mix of pre-tax income in the current year can result in pre-tax income being higher or lower than the prior year in countries with lower statutory tax rates, which causes our effective income tax rate to fluctuate. The impact of such changes could be meaningful in countries with statutory income tax rates that are significantly lower than the U.S. statutory income tax rate of 35%. In 2012, we consolidated international sales and financial management in a newly created international headquarters in Dublin, Ireland. This Irish entity is our principal entity selling to customers in countries outside of North America and Japan. In years before fiscal 2012, sales to these regions were made by our subsidiary in Belgium pursuant to a license which returned most of the Belgium profits back to the U.S. through a royalty arrangement. In connection with the establishment of the international headquarters in Dublin, we implemented a new intellectual property strategy pursuant to which the right to use U.S.-owned intellectual property now resides with our Irish headquarter entity. While our Ireland subsidiaries make royalty and other payments to the U.S., the majority of profits earned by the Irish entities are retained offshore to fund our future growth in Europe, the Middle East, Africa and the Asia Pacific regions. In future periods, if our foreign profits grow, we expect substantially all of our income before income taxes from foreign operations will be earned in Ireland. The statutory rate related to our Ireland profits is lower than the U.S, statutory rate and as a result we would expect our effective tax rate to decrease as profits in Ireland increase.

SEGMENT ANALYSIS

We operate in, and report financial information for, the following four reportable segments: Healthcare, Mobile and Consumer, Enterprise and Imaging.
Segment revenues include certain revenue adjustments related to acquisitions that would otherwise have been recognized but for the purchase accounting treatment of the business combinations. Segment revenues also include revenue that we would have otherwise recognized had we not acquired intellectual property and other assets from the same customer. We include these revenues and the related cost of revenues to allow for more complete comparisons to the financial results of historical operations, forward-looking guidance and the financial results of peer companies and in assessing management performance.
Segment profit is an important measure used for evaluating performance and for decision-making purposes. Segment profit reflects the direct controllable costs of each segment together with an allocation of sales and corporate marketing expenses, and certain research and development project costs that benefit multiple product offerings. Segment profit represents income from operations excluding stock-based compensation, amortization of intangible assets, acquisition-related costs, net, restructuring and other charges, net, costs associated with intellectual property collaboration agreements, other income (expense), net and certain unallocated corporate expenses.

29

Table of Contents

The following table presents segment results (dollars in millions):

Fiscal 2013
 
Fiscal 2012
 
Fiscal 2011
 
% Change 2013 vs. 2012
 
% Change 2012 vs. 2011
Segment Revenues
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Healthcare
$
911.6

 
$
669.4

 
$
526.8

 
36.2
 %
 
27.1
 %
Mobile and Consumer
479.2

 
508.3

 
393.3

 
(5.7
)%
 
29.2
 %
Enterprise
323.5

 
332.0

 
296.4

 
(2.6
)%
 
12.0
 %
Imaging
243.4

 
228.4

 
177.4

 
6.6
 %
 
28.7
 %
Total segment revenues
$
1,957.7

 
$
1,738.1

 
$
1,393.9

 
12.6
 %
 
24.7
 %
Less: acquisition related revenue adjustments
(102.4
)
 
(86.6
)
 
(75.2
)
 
18.2
 %
 
15.2
 %
Total revenues
$
1,855.3

 
$
1,651.5

 
$
1,318.7

 
12.3
 %
 
25.2
 %
Segment Profit
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Healthcare
$
352.2

 
$
314.9

 
$
269.4

 
11.8
 %
 
16.9
 %
Mobile and Consumer
143.0

 
227.6

 
170.9

 
(37.2
)%
 
33.2
 %
Enterprise
78.9

 
90.8

 
63.3

 
(13.1
)%
 
43.4
 %
Imaging
98.2

 
91.6

 
69.1

 
7.2
 %
 
32.6
 %
Total segment profit
$
672.3

 
$
724.9

 
$
572.7

 
(7.3
)%
 
26.6
 %
Segment Profit Margin
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Healthcare
38.6
%
 
47.0
%
 
51.1
%
 
(8.4
)
 
(4.1
)
Mobile and Consumer
29.8
%
 
44.8
%
 
43.5
%
 
(15.0
)
 
1.3

Enterprise
24.4
%
 
27.3
%
 
21.4
%
 
(2.9
)
 
5.9

Imaging
40.3
%
 
40.1
%
 
39.0
%
 
0.2

 
1.1

Total segment profit margin
34.3
%
 
41.7
%
 
41.1
%
 
(7.4
)
 
0.6


Segment Revenue

Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
Healthcare segment revenue increased $242.2 million. Our professional services and hosting revenue increased $149.4 million, primarily due to growth in on-demand transactional volume, of which $141.3 million of the increase resulted from our acquisitions during fiscal 2012 and 2013. Our product and licensing revenues increased $78.0 million primarily driven by a $66.5 million increase in sales of our Clintegrity solutions from our recent acquisitions.
Mobile and Consumer segment revenue decreased $29.1 million. Our product and licensing revenue declined $64.1 million, primarily driven by lower sales of embedded licenses in handset and other consumer electronics resulting from a continuing shift toward on-demand and ratable pricing models. Our professional services and hosting revenue grew $30.3 million primarily attributable to an increase of $23.4 million in on-demand revenue driven by transactional volume growth of our connected mobile services, and an $8.6 million increase in professional services to support the custom design and implementation of our next generation mobile solutions in automobiles, handsets and other consumer electronics.
Enterprise segment revenue decreased $8.5 million. Our product and licensing revenue declined $16.0 million, driven primarily by lower product and licensing revenue in Europe. Maintenance and support revenue increased $8.1 million driven by strong maintenance renewals from license bookings in prior periods.
Imaging segment revenue increased $15.0 million. Our product and licensing revenue grew $11.1 million primarily driven by our fiscal 2012 and 2013 acquisitions.
Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Healthcare segment revenue increased $142.6 million, primarily attributable to revenue growth in on-demand solutions. Professional services and hosting revenue increased $119.7 million due to growth in on-demand transactional volume, of which $77.4 million of the increase was due to additional volume resulting from our acquisitions during fiscal 2011 and 2012.

30

Table of Contents

Mobile and Consumer segment revenue increased $115.0 million. Our product and licensing revenue grew $83.3 million, mainly driven by growth in our embedded handset, automotive and other consumer electronics. Our professional services and hosting revenue grew $32.8 million primarily driven by a $17.7 million increase in professional services to support the implementations of our embedded handset and automotive solutions as well as a $15.0 million increase driven by transactional volume growth in our connected mobile services.
Enterprise segment revenue increased $35.6 million. Our product and licensing revenue grew $25.0 million, driven primarily by contributions from our acquisition of Loquendo. Our maintenance and support revenue grew $8.2 million from the continued strength in renewals.
Imaging segment revenue increased $51.0 million. Our product and licensing revenue grew $32.5 million and our maintenance and support grew $18.2 million, primarily due to growth in sales from our MFP products driven by our acquisition of Equitrac.
Segment Profit
Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
Healthcare segment profit in fiscal 2013 increased $37.3 million, or 11.8%, over fiscal 2012, driven primarily by segment revenue growth of 36.2%, partially offset by increased costs from growth in sales of our on-demand solutions and investments in research and development. Segment profit margin declined 8.4 percentage points from 47.0% in fiscal 2012 to 38.6% in fiscal 2013. This decrease in profit margin was primarily driven by lower segment gross margin of 6.5 percentage points due to pressures in margin resulting from our acquired businesses that have a large service component, yet are not fully at scale and are at a stage that requires significant infrastructure and labor investments for deployment. In addition, profit margin decreased 1.9 percentage points due to increased investments in research in development to support innovation and product initiatives.
Mobile and Consumer segment profit in fiscal 2013 decreased $84.6 million, or 37.2%, over fiscal 2012, primarily due to lower product and licensing revenue and increased investments in research and development. Segment profit margin declined by 15.0 percentage points, from 44.8% in fiscal 2012 to 29.8% in the current period. This decrease in margin was primarily driven by a 6.2 percentage point increase in research and development spending to fund cloud-based speech systems and natural language understanding advancements, as well as a 5.8 percentage point decrease in segment gross margin due to a shift in revenue mix from product and licensing revenue to on-demand and professional services revenue as well as the costs to deploy large solutions for key customers.

Enterprise segment profit in fiscal 2013 decreased $11.9 million, or 13.1%, over fiscal 2012, driven primarily by lower product and licensing revenue in Europe and higher selling expenses. Segment profit margin decreased 2.9 percentage points from 27.3% in fiscal 2012 to 24.4% in fiscal 2013. This decrease in margin was primarily driven by higher sales and marketing expenses, which reduced margins by 3.5 percentage points, offset by gross margin improvement of 0.7 percentage points due to cost-saving measures during the period.
Imaging segment profit in fiscal 2013 increased $6.6 million, or 7.2%, over fiscal 2012, driven primarily by growth in revenue from our acquisitions in fiscal 2012 and 2013. Segment profit margin of 40.3% in 2013 was relatively flat as compared to fiscal 2012.
Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Healthcare segment profit in fiscal 2012 increased $45.5 million, or 16.9%, over fiscal 2011, driven primarily by segment revenue growth of 27.1%, partially offset by increased costs from growth in sales of our on-demand solutions. Segment profit margin decreased 4.1 percentage points from 51.1% in fiscal 2011 to 47.0% in fiscal 2012. This decrease was primarily driven by a decrease of 5.1 percentage points in margin due to a higher proportion of editing services in our on-demand offerings, which included impact of the Transcend acquisition, and a 0.6 percentage point improvement due to leveraging of selling expenses.
Mobile and Consumer segment profit in fiscal 2012 increased $56.7 million, or 33.2%, over fiscal 2011, primarily due to segment revenue growth of 29.2%, partially offset by increased investment in research and development and marketing. Segment profit margin in fiscal 2012 improved 1.3 percentage points from 43.5% in fiscal 2011 to 44.8% in fiscal 2012. This increase was primarily driven by a 2.2 percentage point improvement in margin due to a favorable mix shift toward our embedded product revenue and a 2.5 percentage point improvement due to leveraging of selling expense. These improvements were offset by a 2.0 percentage point decrease in segment profit margin due to increased investment in

31

Table of Contents

research and development to support new product offerings and a 1.1 percentage point decrease as a result of higher marketing demand creation costs to drive Dragon consumer product sales.
Enterprise segment profit in fiscal 2012 increased $27.5 million, or 43.4%, over fiscal 2011, driven primarily by segment revenue growth of 12.0%, partially offset by increased investment in sales expense. Segment profit margin in fiscal 2012 increased 5.9 percentage points from 21.4% in fiscal 2011 to 27.3% in fiscal 2012. This increase benefited from a favorable mix of product and licensing revenues which includes the impact of the acquisition of Loquendo, contributing to an increase in gross margins of 5.3 percentage points, as well as a 1.2 percentage point improvement driven by operating expense leverage in research and development.
Imaging segment profit in fiscal 2012 increased 22.5 million, or 32.6%, over fiscal 2011, driven in part from a 28.7% increase in segment revenue, offset by increased investment in marketing and selling expenses. Segment profit margin increased 1.1 percentage points from 39.0% in fiscal 2011 to 40.1% in fiscal 2012. The change in segment profit margin included a 2.5 percentage point improvement due to leveraging selling expense, offset by 1.9 percentage points of segment margin erosion due to increased marketing spend to drive revenue growth.

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

Cash and cash equivalents and marketable securities totaled $846.8 million as of September 30, 2013, a decrease of $283.0 million as compared to $1,129.8 million as of September 30, 2012. Our working capital at September 30, 2013 was $604.3 million compared to $736.5 million of working capital at September 30, 2012. Cash and cash equivalents and marketable securities held by our international operations totaled $65.8 million and $78.8 million at September 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively. We expect the cash held overseas will continue to be used for our international operations and therefore do not anticipate repatriating these funds. If we were to repatriate these amounts, we do not believe that the resulting withholding taxes payable would have a material impact on our liquidity. As of September 30, 2013, our total accumulated deficit was $369.4 million. We do not expect our accumulated deficit to impact our future ability to operate the business given our strong cash and operating cash flow positions.
The holders of our 2027 Convertible Debentures may require us to redeem the outstanding balance of $250.0 million in August 2014. We expect that we will be able to use our existing cash balances, including cash generated by our operating activities during fiscal 2014, to fund the retirement of the 2027 Debentures, if required by the holders. However, we will assess our operating and investing cash flow requirements and the borrowing economics in the capital markets at that time to determine the appropriate funding source.
We believe our current cash and cash equivalents are sufficient to meet our operating needs for at least the next twelve months.
Cash provided by operating activities
Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
Cash provided by operating activities for fiscal 2013 was $395.0 million, a decrease of $78.0 million, or 16%, as compared to cash provided by operating activities of $473.0 million for fiscal 2012. The net decrease was primarily driven by the following factors:
A decrease of $158.5 million in cash flows resulting from higher net loss, exclusive of non-cash adjustment items which includes a decrease in deferred tax benefit of $149.1 million driven by the change in our valuation allowance;
Offset by an increase of $35.6 million in cash flows generated by changes in working capital excluding deferred revenue; and
An increase in cash flows of $45.0 million from an overall increase in deferred revenue. The increase in deferred revenue was primarily attributable to continued growth in Imaging and Healthcare maintenance and support arrangements, new mobile on-demand service offerings where a portion of the fees are collected upfront, and the emergence of Healthcare term and subscription software arrangements that are recognized ratably.
Fiscal 2012 Compared to Fiscal 2011
Cash provided by operating activities for fiscal 2012 was $473.0 million, an increase of $115.6 million, or 32%, as compared to cash provided by operating activities of $357.4 million for fiscal 2011. The increase was primarily driven by the following factors:
An increase of $89.8 million in cash flows resulting from higher net income, exclusive of non-cash adjustment items which includes deferred tax benefit of $151.5 million driven by the release of our valuation allowance;

32

Table of Contents

An increase of $42.5 million in cash flows generated by changes in working capital excluding deferred revenue, primarily driven by a onetime payment of €18.0 million ($23.4 million equivalent) during the first quarter of fiscal 2011 for a fixed obligation assumed in connection with our acquisition of SpinVox and a $30.8 million increase in cash flows due to changes in accounts payable; and
A decrease in cash flows of $16.8 million from deferred revenue.
Cash used in investing activities
Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
Cash used in investing activities for fiscal 2013 was $693.9 million, a decrease of $230.6 million, or 25%, as compared to cash used in investing activities of $924.5 million for fiscal 2012. The net decrease was primarily driven by the following factors:
A decrease in cash outflows of $277.3 million for business and technology acquisitions;
A decrease in cash outflows of $7.3 million for capital expenditures; and
Offset by an increase in cash outflows of $24.3 million from purchases of marketable securities and other investments and a reduction in cash inflows of $23.0 million from the sales and maturities of marketable securities and other investments.
Fiscal 2012 compared to Fiscal 2011
Cash used in investing activities for fiscal 2012 was $924.5 million, an increase of $498.6 million, or 117%, as compared to cash used in investing activities of $425.9 million for fiscal 2011. The net increase was primarily driven by the following factors:
An increase in cash outflows of $475.9 million for business and technology acquisitions, primarily driven by the cash consideration paid in connection with our acquisitions in fiscal 2012; and
An increase in cash outflows of $28.0 million resulting from additional capital expenditure, primarily related to the purchase of a corporate asset during fiscal 2012.
Cash (used in) provided by financing activities
Fiscal 2013 Compared to Fiscal 2012
Cash used in financing activities for fiscal 2013 was $20.7 million, a decrease of $1,153.7 million, or 102%, as compared to cash provided by financing activities of $1,133.0 million for fiscal 2012. The net decrease was primarily driven by the following factors:
A decrease in cash inflows of $739.8 million from proceeds of debt issuances. Fiscal 2012 activities included cash inflows of $689.1 million from the issuance of the Senior Notes due in 2020, as well as $676.1 million from the issuance of the 2031 Debentures, net of issuance costs and original issue discount. Fiscal 2013 activities included proceeds of $351.7 million of Senior Notes due in 2020 issued in the first quarter of fiscal 2013 together with $277.1 million related to the amendment of our Credit Facility in August 2013;
An increase in cash outflows of $419.0 million for the payment of long-term debt, which includes $277.1 million related to the amendment of our Credit Facility in August 2013 and the October 2012 payment of $143.5 million on our term loan;
An increase in cash outflows of $10.6 million as a result of higher cash payments required to net share settle employee equity awards, due to an increase in vesting activities during fiscal 2013 as compared to fiscal 2012; and

Offset by a decrease in cash outflows of $15.6 million related to our share repurchase program. We repurchased 9.8 million shares of our common stock for total cash outflows of $184.4 million in fiscal 2013 as compared to our repurchase of 8.5 million shares of our common stock for total cash outflows of $200.0 million in fiscal 2012.
Fiscal 2012 compared to Fiscal 2011
Cash provided by financing activities for fiscal 2012 was $1,133.0 million, an increase of $1,127.0 million, or 18,783%, as compared to cash provided by financing activities of $6.0 million for fiscal 2011. The change was primarily driven by the following factors:

33

Table of Contents

A $689.1 million cash inflow resulting from the issuance of the Senior Notes due 2020, net of issuance costs in August 2012;
A $676.1 million cash inflow resulting from the issuance of the 2031 Debentures, net of issuance costs, offset by $200.0 million that we used to repurchase 8.5 million shares of our common stock in October 2011;

Offset by a decrease of $21.1 million cash benefit resulting from excess tax benefits on employee equity awards; and

An increase in cash outflows of $13.0 million as a result of higher cash payments required to net share settle employee equity awards, due to an increase in the number of shares vested and an increase in the intrinsic value of the shares vested as a result of the overall increase in our stock price in fiscal 2012 as compared to fiscal 2011.
Credit Facilities and Debt
5.375% Senior Notes due 2020
On October 22, 2012, we issued an additional $350.0 million aggregate principal amount of our 5.375% Senior notes due 2020 (the "Notes"). The Notes were issued pursuant to an indenture agreement dated August 14, 2012, relating to our existing $700 million aggregate principal amount of 5.375% Senior Notes due in 2020, issued in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2012. Total proceeds received, net of issuance costs, were $351.7 million. On October 31, 2012, we used $143.5 million of the net proceeds to pay the term loans under the Credit Facility originally maturing in March 2013.
On August 14, 2012, we issued $700 million aggregate principal amount of 5.375% Senior Notes due on August 15, 2020, in a private placement. The net proceeds from the Notes were approximately $689.1 million, net of issuance costs. The Notes bear interest at 5.375% per year, payable in cash semi-annually in arrears. The ending unamortized deferred debt issuance costs at September 30, 2013 and 2012 were $13.0 million and $12.1 million, respectively.
The Notes are the unsecured senior obligations of the Company and are guaranteed (the “Guarantees”) on an unsecured senior basis by substantially all of the Company's direct and indirect wholly owned domestic subsidiaries (the “Subsidiary Guarantors”). The Notes and Guarantees rank equally in right of payment with all of the Company's and the Subsidiary Guarantors' existing and future unsecured senior debt and rank senior in right of payment to all of the Company's and the Subsidiary Guarantors' future unsecured subordinated debt. The Notes and Guarantees effectively rank junior to all secured debt of the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors to the extent of the value of the collateral securing such debt and to all liabilities, including trade payables, of the Company's subsidiaries that have not guaranteed the Notes.
At any time before August 15, 2016, we may redeem all or a portion of the Notes at a redemption price equal to 100% of the aggregate principal amount of the Notes to be redeemed, plus a “make-whole” premium and accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date. At any time on or after August 15, 2016, we may redeem all or a portion of the Notes at certain redemption prices expressed as percentages of the principal amount, plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date. At any time and from time to time before August 15, 2015, we may redeem up to 35% of the aggregate outstanding principal amount of the Notes with the net cash proceeds received by the Company from certain equity offerings at a price equal to 105.375%, plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date, provided that the redemption occurs no later than the 120 days after the closing of the related equity offering, and at least 50% of the original aggregate principal amount of the Notes remains outstanding immediately thereafter.
Upon the occurrence of certain asset sales or a change in control, we must offer to repurchase the Notes at a price equal to 100%, in the case of an asset sale, or 101%, in the case of a change of control, of the principal amount plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the repurchase date.
2.75% Convertible Debentures due in 2031
On October 24, 2011, we sold $690 million of 2.75% Convertible Debentures due in 2031 (the “2031 Debentures”) in a private placement. Total proceeds, net of debt issuance costs, were $676.1 million. The 2031 Debentures bear interest at 2.75% per year, payable in cash semiannually in arrears. The 2031 Debentures mature on November 1, 2031, subject to the right of the holders to require us to redeem the 2031 Debentures on November 1, 2017, 2021, and 2026. The 2031 Debentures are general senior unsecured obligations and rank equally in right of payment with all of our existing and future unsecured, unsubordinated indebtedness and senior in right of payment to any indebtedness that is contractually subordinated to the 2031 Debentures. The 2031 Debentures will be effectively subordinated to indebtedness and other liabilities of our subsidiaries.
If converted, the principal amount of the 2031 Debentures is payable in cash and any amounts payable in excess of the principal amount will (based on an initial conversion rate, which represents an initial conversion price of approximately $32.30 per share, subject to adjustment) be paid in cash or shares of our common stock, at our election, only in the following circumstances

34

Table of Contents

and to the following extent: (i) on any date during any fiscal quarter (and only during such fiscal quarter) if the closing sale price of our common stock was more than 130% of the then current conversion price for at least 20 trading days in the period of the 30 consecutive trading days ending on the last trading day of the previous fiscal quarter; (ii) during the five consecutive business-day period following any five consecutive trading-day period in which the trading price for $1,000 principal amount of the Debentures for each day during such five trading-day period was less than 98% of the closing sale price of our common stock multiplied by the then current conversion rate; (iii) upon the occurrence of specified corporate transactions, as described in the indenture for the 2031 Debentures; or (iv) at the option of the holder at any time on or after May 1, 2031. Additionally, we may redeem the 2031 Debentures, in whole or in part, on or after November 6, 2017 at par plus accrued and unpaid interest. Each holder shall have the right, at such holder's option, to require us to repurchase all or any portion of the 2031 Debentures held by such holder on November 1, 2017, November 1, 2021, and November 1, 2026 at par plus accrued and unpaid interest. If we undergo a fundamental change (as described in the indenture for the 2031 Debentures) prior to maturity, holders will have the option to require us to repurchase all or any portion of their debentures for cash at a price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the debentures to be purchased plus any accrued and unpaid interest, including any additional interest to, but excluding, the repurchase date. As of September 30, 2013, no conversion triggers were met. If the conversion triggers were met, we could be required to repay all or some of the aggregate principal amount in cash prior to the maturity date.
2.75% Convertible Debentures due in 2027
We have $250 million of 2.75% convertible senior debentures due in 2027 (“the 2027 Debentures”) that were issued on August 13, 2007 in a private placement. The 2027 Debentures bear an interest rate of 2.75% per annum, payable semi-annually in arrears, and mature on August 15, 2027 subject to the right of the holders of the 2027 Debentures to require us to redeem the 2027 Debentures on August 15, 2014, 2017 and 2022. The 2027 Debentures are general senior unsecured obligations, ranking equally in right of payment to all of our existing and future unsecured, unsubordinated indebtedness and senior in right of payment to any indebtedness that is contractually subordinated to the 2027 Debentures. The 2027 Debentures are effectively subordinated to our secured indebtedness to the extent of the value of the collateral securing such indebtedness and are structurally subordinated to indebtedness and other liabilities of our subsidiaries.
If converted, the principal amount of the 2027 Debentures is payable in cash and any amounts payable in excess of the principal amount will (based on an initial conversion rate, which represents an initial conversion price of approximately $19.47 per share, subject to adjustment as defined therein) be paid in cash or shares of our common stock, at our election, only in the following circumstances and to the following extent: (i) on any date during any fiscal quarter (and only during such fiscal quarter) if the closing sale price of our common stock was more than 120% of the then current conversion price for at least 20 trading days in the period of the 30 consecutive trading days ending on the last trading day of the previous fiscal quarter; (ii) during the five consecutive business-day period following any five consecutive trading-day period in which the trading price for $1,000 principal amount of the Debentures for each day during such five trading-day period was less than 98% of the closing sale price of our common stock multiplied by the then current conversion rate; (iii) upon the occurrence of specified corporate transactions, as described in the indenture for the 2027 Debentures; and (iv) at the option of the holder at any time on or after February 15, 2027. Additionally, we may redeem the 2027 Debentures, in whole or in part, on or after August 20, 2014 at par plus accrued and unpaid interest. Each holder shall have the right, at such holder's option, to require us to repurchase all or any portion of the 2027 Debentures held by such holder on August 15, 2014, August 15, 2017 and August 15, 2022 at par plus accrued and unpaid interest. If we undergo a fundamental change (as described in the indenture for the 2027 Debentures) prior to maturity, holders will have the option to require us to repurchase all or any portion of their debentures for cash at a price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the debentures to be purchased plus any accrued and unpaid interest, including any additional interest to, but excluding, the repurchase date.
The 2027 Debentures are puttable at the holders option in August 2014. As a result, we have classified the obligation in current liabilities at September 30, 2013. Our stock price exceeded the conversion threshold price of $23.36 per share for at least 20 days during the 30 consecutive trading days ended September 30, 2012. Accordingly, the 2027 Debentures were convertible at the holders' option during the quarter ended December 31, 2012 and therefore were classified as current liabilities at September 30, 2012.
The difference between the carrying value of the 2027 Debentures and the $250.0 million principal amount reflects the unamortized portion of the original issue discount recognized upon issuance of the notes, which is being amortized over the expected term of the convertible debt. Because the 2027 Debentures were convertible at September 30, 2012, an amount equal to the $18.4 million unamortized portion of the original issue discount was separately classified in our consolidated balance sheets as temporary equity and referred to as “Equity component of currently redeemable convertible debentures.” At September 30, 2013, we have no temporary equity.

35

Table of Contents

Credit Facility
On August 7, 2013, we entered into an amendment agreement to amend and restate our existing amended and restated credit agreement, as previously amended. The credit agreement was originally dated March 31, 2006, and was amended and restated on April 5, 2007, and further amended and restated on July 7, 2011, and includes a term loan and a $75 million revolving credit line including letters of credit (together, the "Credit Facility"). Of the $483.4 million outstanding term loans originally due March 31, 2016, existing Lenders representing $333.2 million have elected to extend the maturity to August 7, 2019 and the balance of the term loans have been assigned to new lenders who have also agreed to the extended maturity date. The extended term loans bear interest, at our option, at a base rate determined in accordance with the amended and restated credit agreement, plus a spread of 1.75%, or a LIBOR rate plus a spread of 2.75%. Also, under terms of the amendment, the maturity date of our $75 million revolving credit facility has been extended from March 31, 2015 to August 7, 2018. The extended revolving loans bear interest, at our option, at a base rate determined in accordance with the Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, plus a spread of 0.50% to 0.75%, or a LIBOR rate plus a spread of 1.50% to 1.75%, in each case determined based on our consolidated net leverage ratio. As of September 30, 2013, $482.2 million remained outstanding under the term loans, there were $6.5 million of letters of credit issued under the revolving credit line and there were no other outstanding borrowings under the revolving credit line.
Under terms of the amended Credit Facility, interest is payable monthly at a rate equal to the applicable margin plus, at our option, either (a) the base rate which is the corporate base rate of Morgan Stanley, the Administrative Agent, or (b) LIBOR (equal to (i) the British Bankers’ Association Interest Settlement Rates for deposits in U.S. dollars divided by (ii) one minus the statutory reserves applicable to such borrowing). The applicable margin for the borrowings is as follows:
Description
 
Base Rate Margin
 
LIBOR Margin
Term loans maturing August 2019
 
1.75%
 
2.75%
Revolving facility due August 2018
 
0.50% - 0.75% (a)
 
1.50% - 1.75% (a)
(a)
The margin is determined based on our net leverage ratio at the date the interest rates are reset on the revolving credit line.
At September 30, 2013 the applicable margins were 1.75%, with an effective rate of 2.94% on the remaining balance of $482.2 million maturing in August 2019. We are required to pay a commitment fee for unutilized commitments under the revolving credit facility at a rate ranging from 0.375% to 0.50% per annum, based upon our leverage ratio. As of September 30, 2013, the commitment fee rate was 0.375%.

We capitalized debt issuance costs related to the Credit Facility and are amortizing the costs to interest expense using the effective interest rate method, through August 2018 for costs associated with the revolving credit facility and through August 2019 for the remainder of the balance. As of September 30, 2013 and 2012, the ending unamortized deferred financing fees were $2.9 million and $4.1 million, respectively.
Principal payments on the term loan of $482.2 million are due in quarterly installments of $1.2 million through August 2019, at which point the remaining balance becomes due. In addition, an annual excess cash flow sweep, as defined in the Credit Facility, is payable in the first quarter of each fiscal year, based on the excess cash flow generated in the previous fiscal year. We have not generated excess cash flows in any period and no additional payments are required. We will continue to evaluate the extent to which a payment is due in the first quarter of future fiscal years based on excess cash flow generation. At the current time, we are unable to predict the amount of the outstanding principal, if any, that may be required to be repaid in future fiscal years pursuant to the excess cash flow sweep provisions. Any term loan borrowings not paid through the baseline repayment, the excess cash flow sweep, or any other mandatory or optional payments that we may make, will be repaid upon maturity. If only the baseline repayments are made, the annual aggregate principal amount of the term loans repaid would be as follows (dollars in thousands):
Year Ending September 30,
 
Amount
2014
 
$
4,834

2015
 
4,834

2016
 
4,834

2017
 
4,834

2018
 
4,834

Thereafter
 
458,040

Total
 
$
482,210


36

Table of Contents


Our obligations under the Credit Facility are unconditionally guaranteed by, subject to certain exceptions, each of our existing and future direct and indirect wholly-owned domestic subsidiaries. The Credit Facility and the guarantees thereof are secured by first priority liens and security interests in the following: 100% of the capital stock of substantially all of our domestic subsidiaries and 65% of the outstanding voting equity interests and 100% of the non-voting equity interests of first-tier foreign subsidiaries, all our material tangible and intangible assets and those of the guarantors, and any present and future intercompany debt. The Credit Facility also contains provisions for mandatory prepayments of outstanding term loans upon receipt of the following, and subject to certain exceptions: 100% of net cash proceeds from asset sales, 100% of net cash proceeds from issuance or incurrence of debt, and 100% of extraordinary receipts. We may voluntarily prepay borrowings under the Credit Facility without premium or penalty other than breakage costs, as defined with respect to LIBOR-based loans.
Share Repurchase Program
On April 29, 2013, our Board of Directors approved a share repurchase program for up to $500 million of our outstanding shares of common stock. Approximately $315.6 million remained available for stock repurchases as of September 30, 2013, pursuant to our stock repurchase program. We repurchased 9.8 million shares for $184.4 million during the year ended September 30, 2013. These shares were retired upon repurchase. Under the terms of the repurchase program, we expect to continue to repurchase shares from time to time through a variety of methods, which may include open market purchases, privately negotiated transactions, block trades, accelerated stock repurchase transactions, or any combination of such methods. The timing and the amount of any purchases will be determined by management based on an evaluation of market conditions, capital allocation alternatives, and other factors. The share repurchase program does not require us to acquire any specific number of shares and may be modified, suspended, extended or terminated by us at any time without prior notice.
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements, Contractual Obligations, Contingent Liabilities and Commitments
Contractual Obligations

The following table outlines our contractual payment obligations as of September 30, 2013 (dollars in millions):
 
 
Payments Due by Fiscal Year Ended September 30,
Contractual Obligations
 
Total
 
2014
 
2015 and 2016
 
2017 and 2018
 
Thereafter
Credit Facility(1)
 
$
482.2

 
$
4.8

 
$
9.7

 
$
9.7

 
$
458.0

Convertible Debentures(2)
 
940.0

 
250.0

 

 
690.0

 

Senior Notes
 
1,050.0

 

 

 

 
1,050.0

Interest payable on long-term debt(3)
 
565.5

 
97.4

 
180.5

 
162.5

 
125.1

Letter of Credit(4)
 
6.5

 
6.5

 

 

 

Operating leases
 
191.9

 
41.3

 
68.9

 
41.5

 
40.2

Purchase commitments for inventory, property and equipment(5)
 
7.6

 
5.1

 
2.5

 

 

Collaboration agreements(6)
 
3.8

 
3.8

 

 

 

Other long-term liabilities assumed(7)
 
6.0

 
2.5

 
3.5

 

 

Total contractual cash obligations
 
$
3,253.5

 
$
411.4

 
$
265.1

 
$
903.7

 
$
1,673.3


(1)
Principal is paid on a quarterly basis under the Credit Facility.
(2)
Holders of the 2027 Debentures have the right to require us to repurchase the debentures on August 15, 2014, 2017 and 2022. Holders of the 2031 Debentures have the right to require us to redeem the Debentures on November 1, 2017, 2021, and 2026.
(3)
Interest on the Credit Facility is due and payable monthly and is estimated using the effective interest rate as of September 30, 2013. Interest is due and payable semi-annually under 2027 Debentures and 2031 Debentures at a rate of 2.75%. Interest is due and payable semi-annually on the Senior notes at a rate of 5.375%.
(4)
Letters of Credit are in place primarily to secure future operating lease payments.
(5)
These amounts include non-cancelable purchase commitments for property and equipment as well as inventory in the normal course of business to fulfill customers’ orders currently scheduled in our backlog.
(6)
Payments under the research collaboration agreements are payable in cash or common stock at our option.
(7)
Obligations include assumed long-term liabilities relating to restructuring program initiated by a previous acquisition in 2003. The restructuring program related to the closing of a facility with lease term set to expire in 2016. Total contractual obligation

37

Table of Contents

under the lease is $6.1 million. As of September 30, 2013, we have sub-leased certain of the office space related to the facility to unrelated third parties. Total sublease income under contractual terms is expected to be $4.6 million, which ranges from $0.8 million to $1.9 million on an annualized basis through 2016.

The gross liability for unrecognized tax benefits as of September 30, 2013 was $19.6 million. We do not expect a significant change in the amount of unrecognized tax benefits within the next 12 months. We estimate that none of this amount will be paid within the next year and we are currently unable to reasonably estimate the timing of payments for the remainder of the liability.

Contingent Liabilities and Commitments
In connection with some of our acquisitions, we agreed to make contingent cash payments to the former shareholders of certain of the acquired companies. The following represents the contingent cash payments that we may be required to make.

In connection with our acquisition of J.A. Thomas ("JA Thomas") in October 2012, we agreed to make deferred payments to the former shareholders of JA Thomas of up to $25.0 million, payable in cash or shares of our common stock, at our option. The payment is due in October 2014 and is contingent upon the continued employment of certain named executives and certain other conditions. The contingent payments will be reduced by amounts specified in the merger agreement in the event that any of the named executives terminates their employment prior to the payment date.
Financial Instruments
We use financial instruments to manage our foreign exchange risk. We follow Financial Accounting Standards Board Accounting Standards Codification 815 (“ASC 815”), Derivatives and Hedging, for our derivative instruments.
We operate our business in countries throughout the world and transact business in various foreign currencies. Our foreign currency exposures typically arise from transactions denominated in currencies other than the local functional currency of our operations. We have a program that primarily utilizes foreign currency forward contracts to offset the risks associated with foreign currency denominated assets and liabilities. We established this program so that gains and losses from remeasurement or settlement of these assets and liabilities are offset by gains or losses on the foreign currency forward contracts thus mitigating the risks and volatility associated with our foreign currency transactions. Generally, we enter into contracts with terms of 90 days or less, and at September 30, 2013 we had outstanding contracts with a total notional value of $247.8 million.

From time to time we will enter into agreements that allow us to issue shares of our common stock as part or all of the consideration related to partnering and technology acquisition activities. Generally these shares are issued subject to security price guarantees which are accounted for as derivatives. We have determined that these instruments would not be considered equity instruments if they were freestanding. The security price guarantees require payment from either us to the third party, or from the third party to us, based upon the difference between the price of our common stock on the issue date and an average price of our common stock approximately six months following the issue date. Changes in the fair value of these security price guarantees are reported in earnings in each period as other (expense) income, net. During the year ended September 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011, we recorded $(6.6) million, $8.0 million and $13.2 million, respectively of (losses) gains associated with these contracts and (paid) received cash payments totaling $(3.8) million, $9.0 million and $9.4 million, respectively, upon to settlement of the agreements during the year.

Pension Plans
We sponsor certain defined benefit pension plans that are offered primarily by certain of our foreign subsidiaries. Many of these plans were assumed through our acquisitions or are required by local regulatory requirements. We may deposit funds for these plans with insurance companies, third party trustees, or into government-managed accounts consistent with local regulatory requirements, as applicable. Our total defined benefit plan pension expenses were $1.3 million, $0.1 million and $0.3 million for fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. The aggregate projected benefit obligation and aggregate net asset (liability) of our defined benefit plans as of September 30, 2013 was $28.1 million and $0.1 million, respectively, and as of September 30, 2012 was $34.2 million and $(3.2) million, respectively. In fiscal 2013, we settled the obligations under our Canadian defined benefit pension plan through a purchase of annuities. The loss on settlement was $1.5 million, and is included in restructuring and other, net.
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
Through September 30, 2013, we have not entered into any off-balance sheet arrangements or material transactions with unconsolidated entities or other persons.


38

Table of Contents

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES, JUDGMENTS AND ESTIMATES

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements, and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting period. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our estimates, assumptions and judgments, including those related to revenue recognition; allowance for doubtful accounts and sales returns; the valuation of goodwill and intangible assets; accounting for business combinations; accounting for stock-based compensation; accounting for derivative instruments; accounting for income taxes and related valuation allowances; and loss contingencies. Our management bases its estimates on historical experience, market participant fair value considerations and various other factors that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. Actual results could differ from these estimates.

We believe the following critical accounting policies most significantly affect the portrayal of our financial condition and results of operations and require our most difficult and subjective judgments.

Revenue Recognition.  We derive revenue from the following sources: (1) software license agreements, including royalty and other usage-based arrangements, (2) professional services, (3) hosting services and (4) post-contract customer support ("PCS"). Our hosting services are generally provided through on-demand, usage-based or per transaction fee arrangements. Our revenue recognition policies for these revenue streams are discussed below.

The sale and/or license of software products and technology is deemed to have occurred when a customer either has taken possession of or has access to take immediate possession of the software or technology. In select situations, we sell or license intellectual property in conjunction with, or in place of, embedding our intellectual property in software. We also have non-software arrangements including hosting services where the customer does not take possession of the software at the outset of the arrangement either because they have no contractual right to do so or because significant penalties preclude them from doing so. Generally we recognize revenue when (i) persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, (ii) delivery has occurred, (iii) the fee is fixed or determinable and (iv) collectibility is probable.

Revenue from royalties on sales of our software products by original equipment manufacturers (“OEMs”), where no services are included, is recognized in the quarter earned so long as we have been notified by the OEM that such royalties are due, and provided that all other revenue recognition criteria are met.

Software arrangements generally include PCS, which includes telephone support and the right to receive unspecified upgrades/enhancements on a when-and-if-available basis, typically for one to five years. Revenue from PCS is recognized ratably on a straight-line basis over the term that the maintenance service is provided. When PCS renews automatically, we provide a reserve based on historical experience for contracts expected to be canceled for non-payment. All known and estimated cancellations are recorded as a reduction to revenue and accounts receivable.

For our software and software-related multiple element arrangements, where customers purchase both software related products and software related services, we use vendor-specific objective evidence (“VSOE”) of fair value for software and software-related services to separate the elements and account for them separately. VSOE exists when a company can support what the fair value of its software and/or software-related services is based on evidence of the prices charged when the same elements are sold separately. VSOE of fair value is required, generally, in order to separate the accounting for various elements in a software and related services arrangement. We have established VSOE of fair value for the majority of our PCS, professional services, and training.

When we provide professional services considered essential to the functionality of the software, we recognize revenue from the professional services as well as any related software licenses on a percentage-of-completion basis whereby the arrangement consideration is recognized as the services are performed, as measured by an observable input. In these circumstances, we separate license revenue from professional service revenue for income statement presentation by allocating VSOE of fair value of the professional services as professional services and hosting revenue and the residual portion as product and licensing revenue. We generally determine the percentage-of-completion by comparing the labor hours incurred to-date to the estimated total labor hours required to complete the project. We consider labor hours to be the most reliable, available measure of progress on these projects. Adjustments to estimates to complete are made in the periods in which facts resulting in a change become known. When the estimate indicates that a loss will be incurred, such loss is recorded in the period identified. Significant judgments and estimates are involved in determining the percent complete of each contract. Different assumptions could yield materially different results.

We offer some of our products via a Software-as-a-Service ("SaaS") model also known as a hosted model. In this type of arrangement, we are compensated in two ways: (1) fees for up-front set-up of the service environment and (2) fees charged on a

39

Table of Contents

usage or per transaction basis. Our up-front set-up fees are nonrefundable. We recognize the up-front set-up fees ratably over the longer of the contract lives, or the expected lives of the customer relationships. The on-demand, usage-based or per transaction fees are due and payable as each individual transaction is processed through the hosted service and is recognized as revenue in the period the services are provided.

We enter into multiple-element arrangements that may include a combination of our various software related and non-software related products and services offerings including software licenses, PCS, professional services, and our hosting services. In such arrangements we allocate total arrangement consideration to software or software-related elements and any non-software element separately based on the selling price hierarchy group following the guidance in Accounting Standards Codification ("ASC") 985-605, Software Revenue Recognition and our policies. We determine the selling price for each deliverable using VSOE of selling price, if it exists, or Third Party Evidence (“TPE”) of selling price. Typically, we are unable to determine TPE of selling price. Therefore, when neither VSOE nor TPE of selling price exist for a deliverable, we use our Estimate of Selling Price (“ESP”) for the purposes of allocating the arrangement consideration. We determine ESP for a product or service by considering multiple factors including, but not limited to, major project groupings, market conditions, competitive landscape, price list and discounting practices. Revenue allocated to each element is then recognized when the basic revenue recognition criteria are met for each element.

When products are sold through distributors or resellers, title and risk of loss generally passes upon shipment, at which time the transaction is invoiced and payment is due. Shipments to distributors and resellers without right of return are recognized as revenue upon shipment, provided all other revenue recognition criteria are met. Certain distributors and resellers have been granted rights of return for as long as the distributors or resellers hold the inventory. We cannot estimate historical returns from these distributors and resellers; and therefore, cannot use such estimates as the basis upon which to estimate future sales returns. As a result, we recognize revenue from sales to these distributors and resellers when the products are sold through to retailers and end-users.

When products are sold directly to retailers or end-users, we make an estimate of sales returns based on historical experience. The provision for these estimated returns is recorded as a reduction of revenue and accounts receivable at the time that the related revenue is recorded. If actual returns differ significantly from our estimates, such differences could have a material impact on our results of operations for the period in which the actual returns become known.

We record consideration given to a reseller as a reduction of revenue to the extent we have recorded cumulative revenue from the customer or reseller. However, when we receive an identifiable benefit in exchange for the consideration, and can reasonably estimate the fair value of the benefit received, the consideration is recorded as an operating expense.

We record reimbursements received for out-of-pocket expenses as revenue, with offsetting costs recorded as cost of revenue. Out-of-pocket expenses generally include, but are not limited to, expenses related to transportation, lodging and meals. We record shipping and handling costs billed to customers as revenue with offsetting costs recorded as cost of revenue.

Our revenue recognition policies require management to make significant estimates. Management analyzes various factors, including a review of specific transactions, historical experience, creditworthiness of customers and current market and economic conditions. Changes in judgments based upon these factors could impact the timing and amount of revenue and cost recognized and thus affects our results of operations and financial condition.

Business Combinations.  We determine and allocate the purchase price of an acquired company to the tangible and intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed as of the business combination date. The purchase price allocation process requires us to use significant estimates and assumptions, including fair value estimates, as of the business acquisition date, including:

estimated fair values of intangible assets;
estimated fair market values of legal performance commitments to customers, assumed from the acquiree under existing contractual obligations (classified as deferred revenue) at the date of acquisition;
estimated fair market values of stock awards assumed from the acquiree that are included in the purchase price;
estimated fair market value of required payments under contingent consideration provisions;
estimated income tax assets and liabilities assumed from the acquiree; and
estimated fair value of pre-acquisition contingencies assumed from the acquiree.


40

Table of Contents

While we use our best estimates and assumptions as part of the purchase price allocation process to accurately value assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the business combination date, our estimates and assumptions are inherently uncertain and subject to refinement. As a result, during the purchase price allocation period, which is generally one year from the business combination date, we record adjustments to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed, with the corresponding offset to goodwill. For changes in the valuation of intangible assets between preliminary and final purchase price allocation, the related amortization is adjusted effective from the acquisition date. Subsequent to the purchase price allocation period any adjustment to assets acquired or liabilities assumed is included in operating results in the period in which the adjustment is determined.

Although we believe the assumptions and estimates we have made in the past have been reasonable and appropriate, they are based in part on historical experience and information obtained from the management of the acquired companies and are inherently uncertain. Examples of critical estimates in valuing certain of the intangible assets we have acquired or may acquire in the future include but are not limited to:

future expected cash flows from software license sales, support agreements, consulting contracts, other customer contracts and acquired developed technologies and patents;
expected costs to develop in-process research and development projects into commercially viable products and the estimated cash flows from the projects when completed;
the acquired company’s brand and competitive position, as well as assumptions about the period of time the acquired brand will continue to be used in the combined company’s product portfolio; and
discount rates.

Unanticipated events and circumstances may occur which may affect the accuracy or validity of such assumptions, estimates or actual results.

In connection with the purchase price allocations for our acquisitions, we estimate the fair market value of legal performance commitments to customers, which are classified as deferred revenue. The estimated fair market value of these obligations is determined and recorded as of the acquisition date.

For a given acquisition, we may identify certain pre-acquisition contingencies. If, during the purchase price allocation period, we are able to determine the fair value of a pre-acquisition contingency, we will include that amount in the purchase price allocation. If we are unable to determine the fair value of a pre-acquisition contingency at the end of the purchase price allocation period, we will evaluate whether to include an amount in the purchase price allocation based on whether it is probable a liability had been incurred and whether an amount can be reasonably estimated. After the end of the purchase price allocation period, any adjustment to amounts recorded for a pre-acquisition contingency will be included in our operating results as acquisition-related cost, net in the period in which the adjustment is determined.

Goodwill, Intangible and Other Long-Lived Assets and Impairment Assessments.  We have significant long-lived tangible and intangible assets, including goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives, which are susceptible to valuation adjustments as a result of changes in various factors or conditions. The most significant finite-lived tangible and intangible assets are customer relationships, licensed technology, patents and core technology, completed technology, fixed assets and trade names. All finite-lived intangible assets are amortized over the estimated economic lives of the assets, generally using the straight-line method except where the pattern of the expected economic benefit is readily identifiable, primarily customer relationship intangibles, whereby amortization follows that pattern. The values of intangible assets determined in connection with a business combination, with the exception of goodwill, were initially determined by a risk-adjusted, discounted cash flow approach. We assess the potential impairment of intangible and fixed assets whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying values may not be recoverable. Goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets are assessed for potential impairment at least annually, but also whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying values may not be recoverable. Factors we consider important, which could trigger an impairment of such assets, include the following:

significant underperformance relative to historical or projected future operating results;
significant changes in the manner of or use of the acquired assets or the strategy for our overall business;
significant negative industry or economic trends;
significant decline in our stock price for a sustained period; and
a decline in our market capitalization below net book value.


41

Table of Contents

Future adverse changes in these or other unforeseeable factors could result in an impairment charge that would materially impact future results of operations and financial position in the reporting period identified.

We test goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives for impairment annually in the fourth quarter, and between annual tests if indicators of potential impairment exist. The impairment test for goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives compares the fair value of identified reporting unit(s) to its (their) carrying amount to assess whether such assets are impaired. We have six reporting units based on the level of information provided to, and review thereof, by our segment management.

We determine fair values for each of the reporting units using an income approach. When available and appropriate, we also use a comparative market approach to derive the fair values. For purposes of the income approach, fair value is determined based on the present value of estimated future cash flows, discounted at an appropriate risk adjusted rate. We use our internal forecasts to estimate future cash flows and include an estimate of long-term future growth rates based on our most recent views of the long-term outlook for each business. Actual results may differ from those assumed in our forecasts. We derive our discount rates using a capital asset pricing model and analyzing published rates for industries relevant to our reporting units to estimate the cost of equity financing. We use discount rates that are commensurate with the risks and uncertainty inherent in the respective businesses and in our internally developed forecasts. Discount rates used in our reporting unit valuations ranged from 12.0% to 17.5%. For purposes of the market approach, we use a valuation technique in which values are derived based on market prices of comparable publicly traded companies. We also use a market based valuation technique in which values are determined based on relevant observable information generated by market transactions involving comparable businesses. Compared to the market approach, the income approach more closely aligns each reporting unit valuation to our business profile, including geographic markets served and product offerings. Required rates of return, along with uncertainty inherent in the forecasts of future cash flows, are reflected in the selection of the discount rate. Equally important, under this approach, reasonably likely scenarios and associated sensitivities can be developed for alternative future states that may not be reflected in an observable market price. A market approach allows for comparison to actual market transactions and multiples. It can be somewhat more limited in its application because the population of potential comparable entities is often limited to publicly-traded companies where the characteristics of the comparative business and ours can be significantly different, market data is usually not available for divisions within larger conglomerates or non-public subsidiaries that could otherwise qualify as comparable, and the specific circumstances surrounding a market transaction (e.g., synergies between the parties, terms and conditions of the transaction, etc.) may be different or irrelevant with respect to our business. It can also be difficult, under certain market conditions, to identify orderly transactions between market participants in similar businesses. We assess each valuation methodology based upon the relevance and availability of the data at the time we perform the valuation and weight the methodologies appropriately.

The carrying values of the reporting units were determined based on an allocation of our assets and liabilities through specific allocation of certain assets and liabilities, to the reporting units and an apportionment method based on relative size of the reporting units’ revenues and operating expenses compared to the Company as a whole. Goodwill was initially allocated to our reporting units based on the relative fair value of the units at the date we implemented the current reporting unit structure. Goodwill subsequently acquired through acquisitions is allocated to the applicable reporting unit based upon the relative fair value of the acquired business. Certain corporate assets that are not instrumental to the reporting units’ operations and would not be transferred to hypothetical purchasers of the reporting units were excluded from the reporting units’ carrying values.

Based on our assessments, we have not had any impairment charges during our history as a result of our impairment evaluation of goodwill. Significant adverse changes in our future revenues and/or cash flow results, or significant degradation in the enterprise values of comparable companies within our segments, could result in the determination that all or a portion of our goodwill is impaired. However, as of our fiscal 2013 annual impairment assessment date, our estimated fair values of our reporting units substantially exceeded their carrying values.

We periodically review long-lived assets other than goodwill or indefinite-lived intangible assets for impairment whenever events or changes in business circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of the assets may not be fully recoverable or that the useful lives of those assets are no longer appropriate. Each impairment test is based on a comparison of the undiscounted cash flows to the recorded carrying value for the asset or asset group. Asset groups utilized in this analysis are identified as the lowest level grouping of assets for which largely independent cash flows can be identified. If impairment is indicated, the asset or asset group is written down to its estimated fair value.

Significant judgments and estimates are involved in determining the useful lives of our long-lived assets, determining the reporting units and assessing when events or circumstances would require an interim impairment analysis of goodwill or other long-lived assets to be performed. Changes in our organization or management reporting structure, as well as other events and circumstances, including but not limited to technological advances, increased competition and changing economic or market conditions, could result in (a) shorter estimated useful lives, (b) changes to reporting units, which may require alternative methods of estimating fair values or greater disaggregation or aggregation in our analysis by reporting unit, and/or (c) other changes in

42

Table of Contents

previous assumptions or estimates. In turn, this could have a significant impact on our consolidated financial statements through accelerated amortization and/or impairment charges.

Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation.  We account for share-based awards to employees and directors, including grants of employee stock options, purchases under employee stock purchase plans, and restricted awards through recognition of the fair value of the share-based awards as a charge against earnings in the form of stock-based compensation expense. We recognize stock-based compensation expense over the requisite service period, net of estimated forfeitures. We recognize benefits from stock-based compensation in equity using the with-and-without approach for the utilization of tax attributes. Determining the fair value of share-based awards at the grant date requires judgment, including estimating expected dividends, share price volatility and the amount of share-based awards that are expected to be forfeited. If actual results differ significantly from these estimates, stock-based compensation expense and our results of operations could be materially impacted.
Income Taxes. In accordance with Accounting Standards Codification 740, “Income Taxes” ("ASC 740"), we account for income taxes using an asset and liability approach, which requires that the deferred tax consequences of temporary differences between the amounts recorded in our consolidated financial statements and the amounts included in our federal, state and foreign income tax returns to be recognized in the balance sheet. As the income tax returns are not due and filed until after the completion of our annual financial reporting requirements, the amounts recorded for the current period reflect estimates for the tax-based activity for the period. In addition, estimates are often required with respect to, among other things, the appropriate state income tax rates to use in the various states that we and our subsidiaries are required to file, the potential utilization of operating loss carry-forwards and valuation allowances required, if any, for tax assets that may not be realizable in the future. ASC 740 requires balance sheet classification of current and long-term deferred income tax assets and liabilities based upon the classification of the underlying asset or liability that gives rise to a temporary difference. As such, we have historically estimated the future tax consequence of certain items, including bad debts, inventory valuation, and accruals that cannot be deducted for income tax purposes until such expenses are actually paid. We believe the procedures and estimates used in our accounting for income taxes are reasonable and in accordance with established tax law. The income tax estimates used have not resulted in material adjustments to income tax expense in subsequent periods when the estimates are adjusted to the actual filed tax return amounts.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on differences between the financial statement and tax bases of assets and liabilities using enacted tax rates in effect in the years in which the differences are expected to reverse. We do not provide for U.S. income taxes on the undistributed earnings of our foreign subsidiaries, which we consider to be indefinitely reinvested outside of the U.S.

We make judgments regarding the realizability of our deferred tax assets. The balance sheet carrying value of our net deferred tax assets is based on whether we believe that it is more likely than not that we will generate sufficient future taxable income to realize these deferred tax assets after consideration of all available evidence. We regularly review our deferred tax assets for recoverability considering historical profitability, projected future taxable income, the expected timing of the reversals of existing temporary differences and tax planning strategies. In assessing the need for a valuation allowance, we consider both positive and negative evidence related to the likelihood of realization of the deferred tax assets. The weight given to the positive and negative evidence is commensurate with the extent to which the evidence may be objectively verified. As such, it is generally difficult for positive evidence regarding projected future taxable income exclusive of reversing taxable temporary differences to outweigh objective negative evidence of recent financial reporting losses. Generally, cumulative loss in recent years is a significant piece of negative evidence that is difficult to overcome in determining that a valuation allowance is not needed.
By the end of fiscal 2012, our U.S. operations had pre-tax income adjusted for permanent differences for the most recent three-year period. We concluded that this record of cumulative profitability in recent years and our business plan showing continued profitability provided assurance that our future tax benefits more likely than not would be realized. Accordingly, by the end of fiscal 2012, we made a determination that it is more likely than not that certain of our deferred taxes, primarily in the U.S., would be realized which resulted in a release of $70.5 million of our valuation allowance. As of September 30, 2012, we had net domestic deferred tax assets that totaled $10.4 million.
During the third quarter of fiscal 2013, we concluded that the recoverability of our net domestic deferred tax assets is not more likely than not due to two consecutive quarterly reductions in our earnings forecast, primarily due to the continuing shift toward on-demand and ratable product offerings and revenue streams. This represented new negative evidence related to our domestic deferred tax asset recoverability assessment during fiscal 2013. The new evidence led us to establish a valuation allowance, offsetting the tax benefits resulting from our current year domestic losses. We also recorded a $10.4 million tax provision representing the establishment of the valuation allowance related to our net domestic deferred tax assets at the beginning of the year. As of September 30, 2013, we have $86.5 million of valuation allowance against our domestic deferred tax assets.

As of September 30, 2013, we have $139.7 million of valuation allowances recorded against all U.S. deferred tax assets and certain foreign deferred tax assets. If we are subsequently able to utilize all or a portion of the deferred tax assets for which the

43

Table of Contents

remaining valuation allowance has been established, then we may be required to recognize these deferred tax assets through the reduction of the valuation allowance which could result in a material benefit to our results of operations in the period in which the benefit is determined.

We establish reserves for tax uncertainties that reflect the use of the comprehensive model for the recognition and measurement of uncertain tax positions. Under the comprehensive model, when the minimum threshold for recognition is not met, no tax benefit can be recorded. When the minimum threshold for recognition is met, a tax position is recorded as the largest amount that is more than fifty percent likely of being realized upon ultimate settlement.
Loss Contingencies.  We are subject to legal proceedings, lawsuits and other claims relating to labor, service and other matters arising in the ordinary course of business, as discussed in Note 17 of Notes to our Consolidated Financial Statements. Quarterly, we review the status of each significant matter and assess our potential financial exposure. If the potential loss from any claim or legal proceeding is considered probable and the amount can be reasonably estimated, we accrue a liability for the estimated loss. Significant judgment is required in both the determination of probability and the determination as to whether an exposure is reasonably estimable. Because of uncertainties related to these matters, accruals are based only on the best information available at the time. As additional information becomes available, we reassess the potential liability related to our pending claims and litigation and may revise our estimates. Such revisions in the estimates of the potential liabilities could have a material impact on our results of operations and financial position.
RECENTLY ISSUED ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS
In July 2013, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued Accounting Standards Update No. 2013-11, "Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists" (ASU 2013-11) to provide guidance on the presentation of unrecognized tax benefits. ASU 2013-11 requires an entity to present an unrecognized tax benefit, or a portion of an unrecognized tax benefit, as a reduction to a deferred tax asset for a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward, except as follows: to the extent a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward is not available at the reporting date under the tax law of the applicable jurisdiction to settle any additional income taxes that would result from the disallowance of a tax position or the tax law of the applicable jurisdiction does not require the entity to use, and the entity does not intend to use, the deferred tax asset for such purpose, the unrecognized tax benefit should be presented in the financial statements as a liability and should not be combined with deferred tax assets. ASU 2013-11 is effective for us in our first quarter of fiscal 2015 with earlier adoption permitted. ASU 2013-11 should be applied prospectively with retroactive application permitted. We do not believe that this will have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.
In February 2013, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Accounting Standards Update No. 2013-02, “Reporting Amounts Reclassified Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income,” which amends Accounting Standards Codification 220, “Comprehensive Income.” The amended guidance requires entities to provide information about the amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income by component. Additionally, entities are required to present, either on the face of the financial statements or in the notes, significant amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income by the respective line items of net income. The amended guidance does not change the current requirements for reporting net income or other comprehensive income. The amendment is effective prospectively for annual periods, and interim periods within those annual periods, beginning after December 15, 2012. We believe adoption of this new guidance will not have a material impact on our financial statements as these updates have an impact on presentation only.
Item 7A.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
We are exposed to market risk from changes in foreign currency exchange rates, interest rates and equity prices which could affect operating results, financial position and cash flows. We manage our exposure to these market risks through our regular operating and financing activities and, when appropriate, through the use of derivative financial instruments.
Exchange Rate Sensitivity
We are exposed to changes in foreign currency exchange rates. Any foreign currency transaction, defined as a transaction denominated in a currency other than the U.S. dollar, will be reported in U.S. dollars at the applicable exchange rate. Assets and liabilities are translated into U.S. dollars at exchange rates in effect at the balance sheet date and income and expense items are translated at average rates for the period. The primary foreign currency denominated transactions include revenue and expenses and the resulting accounts receivable and accounts payable balances reflected on our balance sheet. Therefore, the change in the value of the U.S. dollar compared to foreign currencies will have either a positive or negative effect on our financial position and results of operations. Historically, our primary exposure has related to transactions denominated in the euro, British pound, Canadian dollar, Japanese yen, Indian rupee and Hungarian forint.
A hypothetical change of 10% in appreciation or depreciation in foreign currency exchange rates from the quoted foreign currency exchange rates at September 30, 2013 would not have a material impact on our revenue, operating results or cash flows in the coming year.
Periodically, we enter into forward exchange contracts to hedge against foreign currency fluctuations. These contracts may or may not be designated as cash flow hedges for accounting purposes. We have in place a program which primarily uses forward contracts to offset the risks associated with foreign currency exposures that arise from transactions denominated in currencies other than the functional currencies of our worldwide operations. The program is designed so that increases or decreases in our foreign currency exposures are offset by gain or losses on the foreign currency forward contracts. These contracts are not designated

44

Table of Contents

as accounting hedges and generally are for periods less than 90 days. The notional contract amount of outstanding foreign currency exchange contracts not designated as cash flow hedges was $247.8 million at September 30, 2013. Based on the nature of the transactions for which the contracts were purchased, a hypothetical change of 10% in exchange rates would not have a material impact on our financial results.
Interest Rate Sensitivity
We are exposed to interest rate risk as a result of our significant cash and cash equivalents, and the outstanding debt under the Credit Facility.
At September 30, 2013, we held approximately $846.8 million of cash and cash equivalents and marketable securities primarily consisting of cash and money-market funds. Due to the low current market yields and the short-term nature of our investments, a hypothetical change in market rates of one percentage point would not have a material effect on the fair value of our portfolio. Assuming a one percentage point increase in interest rates, our interest income on our investments classified as cash and cash equivalents and marketable securities would increase approximately $7.2 million, based on the September 30, 2013 reported balances of our investment accounts.
At September 30, 2013, our total outstanding debt balance exposed to variable interest rates was $482.2 million. A hypothetical change in market rates would have a significant impact on interest expense and amounts payable. Assuming a one percentage point increase in interest rates, our interest expense relative to our outstanding variable rate debt would increase $4.8 million per annum.
Equity Price Risk
We are exposed to equity price risk as a result of security price guarantees that we enter in to from time to time. Generally, these price guarantees are for a period of six months or less, and require payment from either us to a third party, or from the third party to us, based upon changes in our stock price during the contract term. As of September 30, 2013, we have security price guarantees outstanding for approximately 1.1 million shares of our common stock. A 10% change in our stock price during the next six months would not have a material impact on our statements of operations or cash flows.
2027 and 2031 Debentures
The fair value of our 2031 and 2027 Debentures is dependent on the price and volatility of our common stock as well as movements in interest rates. The fair market value of the debentures will generally increase or decrease as the market price of our common stock changes. The fair market value of the debentures will generally increase as interest rates fall and decrease as interest rates rise. The market value and interest rate changes affect the fair market value of the debentures, but do not impact our financial position, cash flows or results of operations due to the fixed nature of the debt obligations. However, increases in the value of our common stock above the stated trigger price for each issuance for a specified period of time may provide the holders of the debentures the right to convert each bond using a conversion ratio and payment method as defined in the debenture agreement.
Our debentures trade in the financial markets, and the fair value at September 30, 2013 was $698.0 million for the 2031 Debentures and $284.0 million for the 2027 Debentures, based on an average of the bid and ask prices for each of the issuances on that day. This compares to conversion values on September 30, 2013 of approximately $399.1 million and $239.9 million for the 2031 Debentures and the 2027 Debentures, respectively. A 10% increase in the stock price over the September 30, 2013 closing price of $18.68 would have an estimated combined $30.4 million increase to the fair value and a combined $63.9 million increase to the conversion value of the debentures. Given the current trading value of the debentures, the greatest value to the holders of the debentures would be to sell the debentures in the open market in order to maximize their return. Based on this, we believe that the holders may not have a significant economic incentive to convert prior to the first redemption date.

Item 8.
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

Nuance Communications, Inc. Consolidated Financial Statements

45

Table of Contents


NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 
Page

46

Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM





Board of Directors and Stockholders
Nuance Communications, Inc.
Burlington, Massachusetts

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Nuance Communications, Inc. as of September 30, 2013 and 2012, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive (loss) income, stockholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 2013. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Nuance Communications, Inc. at September 30, 2013 and 2012, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 2013, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), Nuance Communications, Inc.’s internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2013, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), and our report dated November 27, 2013 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

 
/s/  BDO USA, LLP
 
BDO USA, LLP

Boston, Massachusetts
November 27, 2013

47

Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM


Board of Directors and Shareholders
Nuance Communications, Inc.
Burlington, Massachusetts

We have audited Nuance Communications, Inc.’s internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2013, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (1992) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (the COSO criteria). Nuance Communications, Inc.’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Item 9A, Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
As indicated in the accompanying Item 9A, Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting, management’s assessment of and conclusion on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting did not include the internal controls of certain acquisitions completed during fiscal 2013 which are included in the consolidated balance sheets of Nuance Communications, Inc. as of September 30, 2013, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive loss, stockholders’ equity and cash flows for the year then ended. These excluded acquisitions constituted approximately 0.3% of consolidated assets as of September 30, 2013 and approximately 4.7% of consolidated revenues for the year then ended. The most significant of these acquisitions was Accentus, Inc., which was acquired on November 19, 2012, and constituted approximately 0.3% of consolidated assets and approximately 2.6% of consolidated revenues. Management did not assess the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting of these acquisitions because of the timing of the acquisitions which were completed during fiscal 2013. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting of Nuance Communications, Inc. also did not include an evaluation of the internal control over financial reporting of these acquisitions.
In our opinion, Nuance Communications, Inc. maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2013, based on the COSO criteria.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of Nuance Communications, Inc. as of September 30, 2013 and 2012, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive (loss) income, stockholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 2013 and our report dated November 27, 2013 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.
 
/s/  BDO USA, LLP
 
BDO USA, LLP

Boston, Massachusetts
November 27, 2013

48

Table of Contents

NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

 
Year Ended September 30,
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Revenues:
 

 
 

 
 

Product and licensing
$
753,665

 
$
740,726

 
$
607,358

Professional services and hosting
832,428

 
673,943

 
509,141

Maintenance and support
269,186

 
236,840

 
202,242

Total revenues
1,855,279

 
1,651,509

 
1,318,741

Cost of revenues:
 

 
 

 
 

Product and licensing
99,381

 
74,837

 
65,601

Professional services and hosting
550,881

 
424,733

 
341,055

Maintenance and support
52,705

 
45,325

 
38,057

Amortization of intangible assets
63,583

 
60,034

 
55,111

Total cost of revenues
766,550

 
604,929

 
499,824

Gross profit
1,088,729

 
1,046,580

 
818,917

Operating expenses:
 

 
 

 
 

Research and development
292,081

 
225,441

 
179,377

Sales and marketing
420,184

 
369,205

 
306,439

General and administrative
176,654

 
163,318

 
147,603

Amortization of intangible assets
105,258

 
95,416

 
88,219

Acquisition-related costs, net
29,685

 
58,746

 
21,866

Restructuring and other charges, net
16,385

 
8,268

 
22,862

Total operating expenses
1,040,247

 
920,394

 
766,366

Income from operations
48,482

 
126,186

 
52,551

Other income (expense):
 

 
 

 
 

Interest income
1,615

 
2,234

 
3,159

Interest expense
(137,767
)
 
(85,286
)
 
(36,703
)
Other (expense) income, net
(9,010
)
 
22,168

 
11,010

(Loss) income before income taxes
(96,680
)
 
65,302

 
30,017

Provision (benefit) from income taxes
18,558

 
(141,833
)
 
(8,221
)
Net (loss) income
$
(115,238
)
 
$
207,135

 
$
38,238

Net (loss) income per share:
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
$
(0.37
)
 
$
0.67

 
$
0.13

Diluted
$
(0.37
)
 
$
0.65

 
$
0.12

Weighted average common shares outstanding:
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
313,587

 
306,371

 
302,277

Diluted
313,587

 
320,822

 
315,960


See accompanying notes.

49

Table of Contents


NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE (LOSS) INCOME
 
Year Ended September 30,
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In thousands)
Net (loss) income
$
(115,238
)
 
$
207,135

 
$
38,238

Other comprehensive income (loss):
 
 
 
 
 
Foreign currency translation adjustment
11,244

 
(7,776
)
 
(8,746
)
Pension adjustments
2,599

 
(1,648
)
 
2,895

Unrealized gains (losses) on marketable securities

 
12

 
(42
)
Unrealized losses on cash flow hedge derivatives

 
(20
)
 
(210
)
Total other comprehensive income (loss), net
13,843

 
(9,432
)
 
(6,103
)
Comprehensive (loss) income
$
(101,395
)
 
$
197,703

 
$
32,135



































See accompanying notes.
 


50

Table of Contents

NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
September 30, 2013
 
September 30, 2012
 
(In thousands, except
per share amounts)
ASSETS
Current assets:
 

 
 

Cash and cash equivalents
$
808,118

 
$
1,129,761

Marketable securities
38,728

 

Accounts receivable, less allowances for doubtful accounts of 8,529 and $6,933
382,741

 
381,417

Prepaid expenses and other current assets
104,971

 
102,564

Deferred tax assets
74,969

 
87,564

Total current assets
1,409,527

 
1,701,306

Land, building and equipment, net
143,465

 
116,134

Goodwill
3,293,198

 
2,955,477

Intangible assets, net
953,278

 
906,538

Other assets
159,135

 
119,585

Total assets
$
5,958,603

 
$
5,799,040

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Current liabilities:
 

 
 

Current portion of long-term debt
$
246,040

 
$
148,542

Redeemable convertible debentures

 
231,552

Contingent and deferred acquisition payments

 
49,685

Accounts payable
91,016

 
113,196

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities
214,425

 
215,178

Deferred revenue
253,753

 
206,610

Total current liabilities
805,234

 
964,763

Long-term portion of debt
2,108,091

 
1,735,811

Deferred revenue, net of current portion
160,823

 
108,481

Deferred tax liabilities
162,774

 
160,614

Other liabilities
83,667

 
82,665

Total liabilities
3,320,589

 
3,052,334

Commitments and contingencies (Notes 3, 5, and 17)


 


Equity component of currently redeemable convertible debentures (Note 10)

 
18,430

Stockholders’ equity:
 

 
 

Series B preferred stock, $0.001 par value; 15,000 shares authorized; -0- and 3,562 shares issued and outstanding (liquidation preference $4,631 at September 30, 2012)

 
4,631

Common stock, $0.001 par value; 560,000 shares authorized; 319,365 and 315,821 shares issued and 315,614 and 312,070 shares outstanding
319

 
316

Additional paid-in capital
3,017,074

 
2,908,302

Treasury stock, at cost (3,751 shares)
(16,788
)
 
(16,788
)
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)
6,813

 
(7,030
)
Accumulated deficit
(369,404
)
 
(161,155
)
Total stockholders’ equity
2,638,014

 
2,728,276

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
5,958,603

 
$
5,799,040

See accompanying notes.

51

Table of Contents

NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accumulated
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred Stock
 
Common Stock
 
Additional Paid-In Capital
 
Treasury Stock
 
Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
 
Accumulated Deficit
 
Total Stockholders' Equity
 
Shares
 
Amount
 
Shares
 
Amount
 
 
Shares
 
Amount
 
 
 
 
(In thousands)
Balance at October 1, 2010
3,562

 
$
4,631

 
301,623

 
$
302

 
$
2,581,901

 
3,673

 
$
(16,788
)
 
$
8,505

 
$
(281,355
)
 
$
2,297,196

Issuance of common stock under employee stock plans
 
 
 
 
11,052

 
11

 
36,656

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
36,667

Cancellation of restricted stock, and repurchase of common stock at cost for employee tax withholding
 

 
 

 
(1,996
)
 
(2
)
 
(36,705
)
 
78

 

 
 

 
 

 
(36,707
)
Stock-based compensation
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
112,469

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
112,469

Excess tax benefit from share-based payment plans
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
17,520

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
17,520

Issuance of common stock in connection with acquisitions and collaboration agreements
 

 
 

 
1,777

 
1

 
34,090

 
 

 
 

 
 
 
 

 
34,091

Net income
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
38,238

 
38,238

Other comprehensive loss
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
(6,103
)
 
 

 
(6,103
)
Balance at September 30, 2011
3,562

 
4,631

 
312,456

 
312

 
2,745,931

 
3,751

 
(16,788
)
 
2,402

 
(243,117
)
 
2,493,371

Issuance of common stock under employee stock plans
 
 
 
 
9,891

 
10

 
27,737

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
27,747

Cancellation of restricted stock, and repurchase of common stock at cost for employee tax withholding
 
 
 
 
(2,158
)
 
(2
)
 
(52,000
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(52,002
)
Stock-based compensation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
161,165

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
161,165

Excess tax benefit from share-based payment plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(3,583
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(3,583
)
Repurchase and retirement of common stock
 
 
 
 
(8,514
)
 
(8
)
 
(74,816
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(125,173
)
 
(199,997
)
Equity portion of convertible debt issuance, net of tax effect
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
96,934

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
96,934

Issuance of common stock in connection with acquisitions and collaboration agreements
 
 
 
 
1,070

 
1

 
25,367

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
25,368

Issuance of common stock in connection with warrant exercises
 
 
 
 
3,076

 
3

 
(3
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Reclassification to temporary equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(18,430
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(18,430
)
Net income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
207,135

 
207,135

Other comprehensive loss
 

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(9,432
)
 
 
 
(9,432
)
Balance at September 30, 2012
3,562

 
4,631

 
315,821

 
316

 
2,908,302

 
3,751

 
(16,788
)
 
(7,030
)
 
(161,155
)
 
2,728,276

Issuance of common stock under employee stock plans, net
 
 
 
 
11,261

 
11

 
30,205

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
30,216

Cancellation of restricted stock, and repurchase of common stock at cost for employee tax withholding
 
 
 
 
(2,854
)
 
(3
)
 
(59,688
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(59,691
)
Stock-based compensation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
179,442

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
179,442

Repurchase and retirement of common stock
 
 
 
 
(9,805
)
 
(10
)
 
(91,367
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(93,011
)
 
(184,388
)
Conversion of preferred stock
(3,562
)
 
(4,631
)
 
3,562

 
4

 
4,627

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Issuance of common stock in connection with acquisitions and collaboration agreements
 
 
 
 
1,146

 
1

 
22,461

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
22,462

Reclassification from temporary equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
18,430

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
18,430

Other, net
 
 
 
 
234

 

 
4,662

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4,662

Net loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(115,238
)
 
(115,238
)
Other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
13,843

 
 
 
13,843

Balance at September 30, 2013

 
$

 
319,365

 
$
319

 
$
3,017,074

 
3,751

 
$
(16,788
)
 
$
6,813

 
$
(369,404
)
 
$
2,638,014

See accompanying notes.

52

Table of Contents

NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 
Year Ended September 30,
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In thousands)
Cash flows from operating activities
 

 
 

 
 

Net (loss) income
$
(115,238
)
 
$
207,135

 
$
38,238

Adjustments to reconcile net (loss) income to net cash provided by operating activities:
 

 
 

 
 

Depreciation and amortization
208,659

 
187,183

 
170,933

Stock-based compensation
159,325

 
174,581

 
147,296

Non-cash interest expense
40,019

 
35,497

 
12,510

Non-cash restructuring expense

 

 
11,725

Deferred tax benefit
(2,472
)
 
(151,547
)
 
(43,890
)
Loss (gain) on non-controlling strategic equity interest
790

 
(13,726
)
 

Other
(6,537
)
 
4,016

 
16,492

Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net of effects from acquisitions:
 

 
 

 
 

Accounts receivable
25,165

 
(55,210
)
 
(25,530
)
Prepaid expenses and other assets
10,988

 
13,881

 
(11,793
)
Accounts payable
(26,843
)
 
22,645

 
(8,193
)
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
16,506

 
8,939

 
(6,775
)
Deferred revenue
84,648

 
39,605

 
56,398

Net cash provided by operating activities
395,010

 
472,999

 
357,411

Cash flows from investing activities
 

 
 

 
 

Capital expenditures
(55,588
)
 
(62,910
)
 
(34,907
)
Payments for business and technology acquisitions, net of cash acquired
(607,653
)
 
(884,945
)
 
(409,005
)
Purchases of marketable securities and other investments
(39,435
)
 
(15,156
)
 
(10,776
)
Proceeds from sales and maturities of marketable securities and other investments
8,768

 
31,789

 
11,650

Change in restricted cash balances

 
6,747

 
17,184

Net cash used in investing activities
(693,908
)
 
(924,475
)
 
(425,854
)
Cash flows from financing activities
 

 
 

 
 

Payments of debt
(425,634
)
 
(6,605
)
 
(7,535
)
Proceeds from long-term debt, net of issuance costs
625,155

 
1,364,925

 
(2,553
)
Payments for repurchase of common stock
(184,388
)
 
(199,997
)
 

Payments on other long-term liabilities
(1,688
)
 
(8,525
)
 
(10,643
)
Proceeds from settlement of share-based derivatives, net
(3,801
)
 
9,020

 
9,414

Excess tax benefits on employee equity awards

 
(3,583
)
 
17,520

Proceeds from issuance of common stock from employee stock plans
30,216

 
27,747

 
36,667

Cash used to net share settle employee equity awards
(60,517
)
 
(49,947
)
 
(36,908
)
Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities
(20,657
)
 
1,133,035

 
5,962

Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
(2,088
)
 
978

 
(6,925
)
Net (decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents
(321,643
)
 
682,537

 
(69,406
)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
1,129,761

 
447,224

 
516,630

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
$
808,118

 
$
1,129,761

 
$
447,224


See accompanying notes.

53

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 
1.
Organization and Presentation

Nuance Communications, Inc. (“we,” “Nuance,” or “the Company”) is a leading provider of voice and language solutions for businesses and consumers around the world. Our technologies, applications and services make the user experience more compelling by transforming the way people interact with devices and systems. Our solutions are used for tasks and services such as requesting information from a phone-based self-service solution, dictating medical records, searching the mobile Web by voice, entering a destination into a navigation system, or working with PDF documents. Our solutions help make these interactions, tasks and experiences more productive, compelling and efficient.

We leverage our global professional services organization and our extensive network of partners to design and deploy innovative solutions for businesses and organizations around the globe. We market and sell our products directly through a dedicated sales force, our e-commerce website and a global network of resellers, including system integrators, independent software vendors, value-added resellers, hardware vendors, telecommunications carriers and distributors.

We have built a portfolio of intellectual property, technologies, applications and solutions through both internal development and acquisitions. We expect to continue to pursue opportunities to expand our assets, geographic presence, distribution network and customer base through acquisitions of other businesses and technologies. Significant business acquisitions during fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011 were as follows:

May 31, 2013Tweddle Technology Solutions Segment ("TGT")
October 1, 2012 —J.A. Thomas and Associates, Inc. ("JA Thomas")
June 1, 2012 —Vlingo Corporation ("Vlingo")
April 26, 2012 —Transcend Services, Inc. ("Transcend")
June 16, 2011 — SVOX, A.G. ("SVOX")
June 15, 2011 — Equitrac Corporation ("Equitrac")

The results of operations from the acquired businesses have been included in our consolidated financial statements from their respective acquisition dates. See Note 3 for additional disclosure related to each of these acquisitions.
We operate in four reportable segments; Healthcare, Mobile and Consumer, Enterprise, and Imaging. See Note 20 for a description of each of these segments.

2.
Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Use of Estimates
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements, and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting period. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our estimates, assumptions and judgments. The most important of these relate to revenue recognition; the allowances for doubtful accounts and sales returns; the valuation of goodwill and intangible assets; accounting for business combinations; accounting for stock-based compensation; the accounting for derivative instruments; accounting for income taxes and related valuation allowances; and loss contingencies. We base our estimates on historical experience, market participant fair value considerations and various other factors that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. Actual amounts could differ significantly from these estimates.

Basis of Consolidation
The consolidated financial statements include our accounts and those of our wholly-owned domestic and foreign subsidiaries. Intercompany transactions and balances have been eliminated.


54

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





Revenue Recognition
We derive revenue from the following sources: (1) software license agreements, including royalty and other usage-based arrangements, (2) professional services, (3) hosting services and (4) post-contract customer support ("PCS"). Our hosting services are generally provided through on-demand, usage-based or per transaction fee arrangements. Generally we recognize revenue when (i) persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, (ii) delivery has occurred, (iii) the fee is fixed or determinable and (iv) collectibility is probable. Our revenue recognition policies for these revenue streams are discussed below.

The sale and/or license of software products and technology is deemed to have occurred when a customer either has taken possession of or has access to take immediate possession of the software or technology. In select situations, we sell or license intellectual property in conjunction with, or in place of, embedding our intellectual property in software. We also have non-software arrangements including hosting services where the customer does not take possession of the software at the outset of the arrangement either because they have no contractual right to do so or because significant penalties preclude them from doing so.

Revenue from royalties on sales of our software products by original equipment manufacturers (“OEMs”), where no services are included, is recognized in the quarter earned so long as we have been notified by the OEM that such royalties are due, and provided that all other revenue recognition criteria are met.

Software arrangements generally include PCS, which includes telephone support and the right to receive unspecified upgrades/enhancements on a when-and-if-available basis, typically for one to five years. Revenue from PCS is generally recognized ratably on a straight-line basis over the term that the maintenance service is provided. When PCS renews automatically, we provide a reserve based on historical experience for contracts expected to be canceled for non-payment. All known and estimated cancellations are recorded as a reduction to revenue and accounts receivable.

For our software and software-related multiple element arrangements, where customers purchase both software related products and software related services, we use vendor-specific objective evidence (“VSOE”) of fair value for software and software-related services to separate the elements and account for them separately. VSOE exists when a company can support what the fair value of its software and/or software-related services is based on evidence of the prices charged when the same elements are sold separately. VSOE of fair value is required, generally, in order to separate the accounting for various elements in a software and related services arrangement. We have established VSOE of fair value for the majority of our PCS, professional services, and training.

When we provide professional services considered essential to the functionality of the software, we recognize revenue from the professional services as well as any related software licenses on a percentage-of-completion basis whereby the arrangement consideration is recognized as the services are performed, as measured by an observable input. In these circumstances, we separate license revenue from professional service revenue for income statement presentation by allocating VSOE of fair value of the professional services as professional services and hosting revenue and the residual portion as product and licensing revenue. We generally determine the percentage-of-completion by comparing the labor hours incurred to-date to the estimated total labor hours required to complete the project. We consider labor hours to be the most reliable, available measure of progress on these projects. Adjustments to estimates to complete are made in the periods in which facts resulting in a change become known. When the estimate indicates that a loss will be incurred, such loss is recorded in the period identified. Significant judgments and estimates are involved in determining the percent complete of each contract. Different assumptions could yield materially different results.

We offer some of our products via a Software-as-a-Service ("SaaS") model also known as a hosted model. In this type of arrangement, we are compensated in two ways: (1) fees for up-front set-up of the service environment and (2) fees charged on a usage or per transaction basis. Our up-front set-up fees are nonrefundable. We recognize the up-front set-up fees ratably over the longer of the contract lives, or the expected lives of the customer relationships. The on-demand, usage-based or per transaction fees are due and payable as each individual transaction is processed through the hosted service and is recognized as revenue in the period the services are provided.
 
We enter into multiple-element arrangements that may include a combination of our various software related and non-software related products and services offerings including software licenses, PCS, professional services, and our hosting services. In such arrangements we allocate total arrangement consideration to software or software-related elements and any non-software element separately based on the selling price hierarchy group following the guidance in ASC 985-605 and our policies. We determine the selling price for each deliverable using VSOE of selling price, if it exists, or Third Party Evidence (“TPE”) of selling price. Typically, we are unable to determine TPE of selling price. Therefore, when neither VSOE nor TPE of selling price exist for a deliverable, we use our Estimate of Selling Price (“ESP”) for the purposes of allocating the arrangement consideration. We determine

55

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





ESP for a product or service by considering multiple factors including, but not limited to, major project groupings, market conditions, competitive landscape, price list and discounting practices. Revenue allocated to each element is then recognized when the basic revenue recognition criteria are met for each element.

When products are sold through distributors or resellers, title and risk of loss generally passes upon shipment, at which time the transaction is invoiced and payment is due. Shipments to distributors and resellers without right of return are recognized as revenue upon shipment, provided all other revenue recognition criteria are met. Certain distributors and resellers have been granted rights of return for as long as the distributors or resellers hold the inventory. We cannot use historical returns from these distributors and resellers as a basis upon which to estimate future sales returns. As a result, we recognize revenue from sales to these distributors and resellers when the products are sold through to retailers and end-users.

When products are sold directly to retailers or end-users, we make an estimate of sales returns based on historical experience. The provision for these estimated returns is recorded as a reduction of revenue and accounts receivable at the time that the related revenue is recorded. If actual returns differ significantly from our estimates, such differences could have a material impact on our results of operations for the period in which the actual returns become known.

We record consideration given to a reseller as a reduction of revenue to the extent we have recorded cumulative revenue from the customer or reseller. However, when we receive an identifiable benefit in exchange for the consideration, and can reasonably estimate the fair value of the benefit received, the consideration is recorded as an operating expense.

We record reimbursements received for out-of-pocket expenses as revenue, with offsetting costs recorded as cost of revenue. Out-of-pocket expenses generally include, but are not limited to, expenses related to transportation, lodging and meals. We record shipping and handling costs billed to customers as revenue with offsetting costs recorded as cost of revenue.

Deferred revenue at September 30, 2013 and 2012 was as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
September 30,
2013
 
September 30,
2012
Current Liabilities:
 

 
 

Deferred maintenance revenue
$
134,213

 
$
114,036

Unearned revenue
119,540

 
92,574

Total current deferred revenue
$
253,753

 
$
206,610

Long-term Liabilities:
 

 
 

Deferred maintenance revenue
$
51,784

 
$
43,763

Unearned revenue
109,039

 
64,718

Total long-term deferred revenue
$
160,823

 
$
108,481


Business Combinations
We determine and allocate the purchase price of an acquired company to the tangible and intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed as of the business combination date. Results of operations and cash flows of acquired companies are included in our operating results from the date of acquisition. The purchase price allocation process requires us to use significant estimates and assumptions, including fair value estimates, as of the business combination date including:

estimated fair values of intangible assets;
estimated fair market values of legal performance commitments to customers, assumed from the acquiree under existing contractual obligations (classified as deferred revenue);
estimated fair market values of stock awards assumed from the acquiree that are included in the purchase price;
estimated fair market value of required payments under contingent consideration provisions;
estimated income tax assets and liabilities assumed from the acquiree; and
estimated fair value of pre-acquisition contingencies assumed from the acquiree.


56

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





While we use our best estimates and assumptions as part of the purchase price allocation process to accurately value assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the business combination date, our estimates and assumptions are inherently uncertain and subject to refinement. As a result, during the purchase price allocation period, which is generally one year from the business combination date, we record adjustments to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed, with the corresponding offset to goodwill. For changes in the valuation of intangible assets between preliminary and final purchase price allocation, the related amortization is adjusted effective from the acquisition date. Subsequent to the purchase price allocation period, any adjustment to assets acquired or liabilities assumed is included in operating results in the period in which the adjustment is determined.

Goodwill and Indefinite-Lived Intangible Assets
Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price in a business combination over the fair value of net tangible and intangible assets acquired. Goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives are not amortized, but rather the carrying amounts of these assets are reviewed for impairment at least annually or whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of these assets may not be recoverable. Our annual impairment assessment date is July 1 of each fiscal year. Goodwill is evaluated for impairment based on a comparison of the fair value of our reporting units to their recorded carrying values. We have six reporting units based on the level of information provided to, and review thereof, by our segment management.

We determine fair values for each of the reporting units using an income approach. When available and appropriate, we also use a comparative market approach to derive the fair values. For purposes of the income approach, fair value is determined based on the present value of estimated future cash flows, discounted at an appropriate risk adjusted rate. We use our internal forecasts to estimate future cash flows and include an estimate of long-term future growth rates based on our most recent views of the long-term outlook for each business. Actual results may differ from those assumed in our forecasts. We derive our discount rates using a capital asset pricing model and analyzing published rates for industries relevant to our reporting units to estimate the cost of equity financing. We use discount rates that are commensurate with the risks and uncertainty inherent in the respective businesses and in our internally developed forecasts. Discount rates used in our reporting unit valuations ranged from 12.0% to 17.5%. For purposes of the market approach, we use a valuation technique in which values are derived based on market prices of comparable publicly traded companies. We also use a market based valuation technique in which values are determined based on relevant observable information generated by market transactions involving comparable businesses. We assess each valuation methodology based upon the relevance and availability of the data at the time we perform the valuation and weight the methodologies appropriately. The carrying values of the reporting units were determined based on an allocation of our assets and liabilities through specific allocation of certain assets and liabilities to the reporting units and an apportionment method based on relative size of the reporting units’ revenues and operating expenses compared to the Company as a whole. Certain corporate assets and liabilities that are not instrumental to the reporting units’ operations and would not be transferred to hypothetical purchasers of the reporting units were excluded from the reporting units’ carrying values.

Long-Lived Assets
Our long-lived assets consist principally of acquired intangible assets and land, building and equipment. Land, building and equipment are stated at cost. Building and equipment are depreciated over their estimated useful lives. Leasehold improvements are depreciated over the shorter of the related lease term or the estimated useful life. Costs of significant improvements on existing software for internal use are capitalized and depreciated over the estimated useful life. Depreciation is computed using the straight-line method. Repair and maintenance costs are expensed as incurred. The cost and related accumulated depreciation of sold or retired assets are removed from the accounts and any gain or loss is included in operations.

We include in our amortizable intangible assets those intangible assets acquired in our business and asset acquisitions, including certain technology that is licensed from third parties. We amortize acquired intangible assets with finite lives over the estimated economic lives of the assets, generally using the straight-line method except where the pattern of the expected economic benefit is readily identifiable, primarily customer relationship intangibles, whereby amortization follows that pattern. Each period, we evaluate the estimated remaining useful life of acquired and licensed intangible assets, as well as land, buildings and equipment, to determine whether events or changes in circumstances warrant a revision to the remaining period of depreciation or amortization.

We evaluate long-lived assets for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying value of an asset or asset group may not be recoverable. We assess the recoverability of the asset or asset group based on the undiscounted future cash flows the assets are expected to generate, and recognize an impairment loss when estimated undiscounted future cash flows expected to result from the use of the assets plus net proceeds expected from disposition of the assets, if any, are less than the carrying value of the assets. If an asset or asset group is deemed to be impaired, the amount of the impairment loss, if any, represents the excess of the asset or asset group’s carrying value compared to its estimated fair value.

57

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)






Cash and Cash Equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents consists of cash on hand, including money market funds and time deposits with original maturities of 90 days or less.
Marketable Securities and Minority Investments
Marketable Securities:  Marketable securities consist of time deposits and high-quality corporate debt instruments with stated maturities of more than 90 days. Investments are classified as available-for-sale and are recorded on the balance sheet at fair value with unrealized gains or losses reported as a separate component of accumulated other comprehensive income, net of tax. As of September 30, 2013, the total cost basis of our marketable securities was $38.7 million.

Minority Investment:  We record investments in other companies, where we do not have a controlling interest or significant influence in the equity investment, at cost within other assets in our consolidated balance sheet. We review our investments for impairment whenever declines in estimated fair value are deemed to be other-than-temporary.

Accounts Receivable Allowances
Allowances for Doubtful Accounts:  We maintain an allowance for doubtful accounts for the estimated probable losses on uncollectible accounts receivable. The allowance is based upon the credit worthiness of our customers, our historical experience, the age of the receivable and current market and economic conditions. Receivables are written off against these allowances in the period they are determined to be uncollectible.
Allowances for Sales Returns:  We maintain an allowance for sales returns from customers for which we have the ability to estimate returns based on historical experience. The returns allowance is recorded as a reduction in revenue and accounts receivable at the time the related revenue is recorded. Receivables are written off against the allowance in the period the return is received.
For the years ended September 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011, the activity related to accounts receivable allowances was as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
Allowance for Doubtful Accounts
 
Allowance for Sales Returns
Balance at October 1, 2010
$
6,301

 
$
6,829

Bad debt provision
1,332

 

Write-offs, net of recoveries
(1,926
)
 

Revenue adjustments, net

 
(596
)
Balance at September 30, 2011
$
5,707

 
$
6,233

Bad debt provisions
2,706

 

Write-offs, net of recoveries
(1,480
)
 

Revenue adjustments, net

 
3,635

Balance at September 30, 2012
$
6,933

 
$
9,868

Bad debt provisions
4,781

 

Write-offs, net of recoveries
(3,185
)
 

Revenue adjustments, net

 
(4,208
)
Balance at September 30, 2013
$
8,529

 
$
5,660


Inventories
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost, computed using the first-in, first-out method, or market value and are included in other current assets. We regularly review inventory quantities on hand and record a provision for excess and/or obsolete inventory primarily based on future purchase commitments with our suppliers, and the estimated utility of our inventory as well as other factors including technological changes and new product development.

58

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





Inventories, net of allowances, consisted of the following (dollars in thousands):
 
September 30,
2013
 
September 30,
2012
Components and parts
$
11,504

 
$
7,562

Finished products
3,212

 
3,813

 
$
14,716

 
$
11,375


Accounting for Collaboration Agreements
Healthcare Collaboration Agreement
In June 2011, we entered into an agreement with a large healthcare provider to acquire certain data for $10.0 million, to be used in a joint development project. In addition, under the terms of the arrangement we will be reimbursed for certain research and development costs related to specified product development projects with the objective of commercializing the resulting products. All intellectual property derived from these research and development efforts will be owned by us. Upon product introduction, we will pay royalties to this party based on the actual sales. At the end of five years, the party can elect to continue with the arrangement, receiving royalties on future sales, or receive a buy-out payment from us and forgo future royalties. The buy-out payment is calculated based on a number of factors including the net cash flows received and paid by the parties, as well as a minimum return on those net cash flows. As of September 30, 2013, we have estimated that no payment will be required if the buy-out option is exercised in 2016.

As of the execution of the above arrangement, we have other arrangements where we have sold and will continue to sell our products and services to this party. As a result, under the guidance of ASC 605, Revenue Recognition, we are required to reduce the revenue recognized by the amount we pay to this customer, up to our historical revenue recorded from them. We have therefore reduced reported revenue by $10.0 million for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2011.
The above development arrangement will be accounted for in accordance with ASC 730, Research and Development. Accordingly, any buy-out obligation will be recorded as a liability and any reimbursement of the research and development costs in excess of the buy-out obligation will be recorded as an offset to research and development costs. Royalties paid to this party upon commercialization of any products from these development efforts will be recorded as a reduction to revenue in accordance with ASC 605. For fiscal year ended September 30, 2013 and September 30, 2012, $2.2 million and $5.8 million respectively of expense reimbursement has been recorded as a reduction in research and development expense. In April 2013, we signed Amendment No. 1 to the agreement. Under terms of the amendment, funding for future research and development expenses ended effective September 30, 2013.

Intellectual Property Collaboration Agreements
In order to gain access to a third party’s extensive speech recognition technology, natural language and semantic processing technology, in fiscal 2010 and 2011, we entered into intellectual property collaboration agreements with terms up to six years. Generally, the agreements call for annual payments in cash or shares of our common stock, at our election. The final payments under the current agreements are due in 2014 and total $3.8 million. Depending on the agreement, some or all intellectual property derived from these collaborations will be jointly owned by the two parties. For the majority of the developed intellectual property, we will have sole rights to commercialize such intellectual property for periods ranging between two to six years, depending on the agreement. We issued 1.1 million and 1.0 million shares of our common stock for payments totaling $22.5 million and $23.4 million in each of the fiscal years ending in 2013 and 2012, respectively.
The payments are recorded as a prepaid asset when made, and will be expensed ratably over the contractual period. For the years ended September 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011, we have recognized $20.6 million, $21.0 million, and $19.8 million as research and development expense, respectively, related to these agreements in our consolidated statements of operations.

Research and Development Costs
Research and development costs related to software that is or will be sold or licensed externally to third-parties, or for which a substantive plan exists to sell or license such software in the future, incurred subsequent to the establishment of technological feasibility, but prior to the general release of the product, are capitalized and amortized to cost of revenue over the estimated useful life of the related products. We have determined that technological feasibility is reached shortly before the general release of our

59

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





software products. Costs incurred after technological feasibility is established have not been material. We expense research and development costs as incurred.

Acquisition-Related Costs, net
Acquisition-related costs (income) include those costs related to business and other acquisitions, including potential acquisitions. These costs consist of (i) transition and integration costs, including retention payments, transitional employee costs and earn-out payments treated as compensation expense, as well as the costs of integration-related activities including services provided by third-parties; (ii) professional service fees, including third-party costs related to the acquisitions, and legal and other professional service fees associated with disputes and regulatory matters related to acquired entities; and (iii) adjustments to acquisition-related items that are required to be marked to fair value each reporting period, such as contingent consideration, and other items related to acquisitions for which the measurement period has ended. The following is a summary of acquisition-related costs (income) reported for the years ended September 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively (dollars in thousands):
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Transition and integration costs
$
28,302

 
$
9,888

 
$
3,361

Professional service fees
20,381

 
48,401

 
18,030

Acquisition-related adjustments
(18,998
)
 
457

 
475

Total
$
29,685

 
$
58,746

 
$
21,866

Included in Acquisition-related adjustments for the year ended September 30, 2013, is income of $17.8 million related to the elimination of a contingent liability established in the original allocation of purchase price for an acquisition closed in fiscal 2007 following the expiration of the applicable statute of limitations.  As a result, we have eliminated the contingent liability, and included the adjustment in acquisition-related costs, net in our consolidated statements of operations.
Advertising Costs
Advertising costs are expensed as incurred and are classified as sales and marketing expenses. Cooperative advertising programs reimburse customers for marketing activities for certain of our products, subject to defined criteria. Cooperative advertising obligations are accrued and expensed at the same time the related revenue is recognized. Cooperative advertising expenses are recorded as expense to the extent that an advertising benefit separate from the revenue transaction can be identified and the cash paid does not exceed the fair value of that advertising benefit received. Any excess of cash paid over the fair value of the advertising benefit received is recorded as a reduction in revenue. We incurred advertising costs of $52.1 million, $48.2 million and $35.2 million for fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

Convertible Debt
We separately account for the liability (debt) and equity (conversion option) components of our convertible debt instruments that require or permit settlement in cash upon conversion in a manner that reflects our nonconvertible debt borrowing rate at the time of issuance. The equity components of our convertible debt instruments are recorded to stockholders’ equity with an offsetting debt discount. The debt discount created is amortized to interest expense in our consolidated statement of operations using the effective interest method over the expected term of the convertible debt.

Income Taxes
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on differences between the financial statement and tax bases of assets and liabilities using enacted tax rates in effect in the years in which the differences are expected to reverse. We do not provide for U.S. income taxes on the undistributed earnings of our foreign subsidiaries, which we consider to be indefinitely reinvested outside of the U.S.

We make judgments regarding the realizability of our deferred tax assets. The balance sheet carrying value of our net deferred tax assets is based on whether we believe that it is more likely than not that we will generate sufficient future taxable income to realize these deferred tax assets after consideration of all available evidence. We regularly review our deferred tax assets for recoverability considering historical profitability, projected future taxable income, the expected timing of the reversals of existing temporary differences and tax planning strategies. In assessing the need for a valuation allowance, we consider both positive and negative evidence related to the likelihood of realization of the deferred tax assets. The weight given to the positive and negative evidence is commensurate with the extent to which the evidence may be objectively verified. As such, it is generally difficult for

60

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





positive evidence regarding projected future taxable income exclusive of reversing taxable temporary differences to outweigh objective negative evidence of recent financial reporting losses. Generally, cumulative loss in recent years is a significant piece of negative evidence that is difficult to overcome in determining that a valuation allowance is not needed.

As of September 30, 2013, valuation allowances have been established for all U.S. and for certain foreign deferred tax assets, which we believe do not meet the “more likely than not” criteria for recognition. If we are subsequently able to utilize all or a portion of the deferred tax assets for which a valuation allowance has been established, then we may be required to recognize these deferred tax assets through the reduction of the valuation allowance which could result in a material benefit to our results of operations in the period in which the benefit is determined.

Comprehensive Income (Loss)
Pursuant to our adoption of Accounting Standard Update No. 2011-05, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220) - Presentation of Comprehensive Income and Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-12, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220) - Deferral of the Effective Date for Amendments to the Presentation of Reclassification of Items Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income in Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-05, we elected to present separate consolidated statements of comprehensive income for fiscal 2013, 2012, and 2011.
For the purposes of comprehensive income (loss) disclosures, we do not record tax provisions or benefits for the net changes in the foreign currency translation adjustment, as we intend to reinvest undistributed earnings in our foreign subsidiaries permanently.

The components of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), reflected in the consolidated statements of stockholders’ equity, consisted of the following (dollars in thousands):
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Foreign currency translation adjustment
$
7,788

 
$
(3,456
)
 
$
4,320

Unrealized losses on marketable securities

 

 
(12
)
Net unrealized gains on cash flow hedge derivatives

 

 
20

Net unrealized losses on post-retirement benefits
(975
)
 
(3,574
)
 
(1,926
)
Total
$
6,813

 
$
(7,030
)
 
$
2,402


Concentration of Risk
Financial instruments that potentially subject us to significant concentrations of credit risk principally consist of cash, cash equivalents, marketable securities and trade accounts receivable. We place our cash and cash equivalents and marketable securities with financial institutions with high credit ratings. As part of our cash and investment management processes, we perform periodic evaluations of the credit standing of the financial institutions with whom we maintain deposits, and have not recorded any credit losses to-date. For trade accounts receivable, we perform ongoing credit evaluations of our customers’ financial condition and limit the amount of credit extended when deemed appropriate. At September 30, 2013 and 2012, no customer accounted for greater than 10% of our net accounts receivable balance or 10% of our revenue for fiscal 2013, 2012 or 2011.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments
Financial instruments including cash equivalents, marketable securities, accounts receivable, accounts payable, and derivative instruments, are carried in the financial statements at amounts that approximate their fair value based on the short maturities of those instruments. Refer to Note 10 for discussion of the fair value of our long-term debt.

61

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





Foreign Currency Translation
We have significant foreign operations and transact business in various foreign currencies. In general, the functional currency of a foreign operation is the local country’s currency. Non-functional currency monetary balances are re-measured into the functional currency of the subsidiary with any related gain or loss recorded in other income (expense), net, in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations. Assets and liabilities of operations outside the United States, for which the functional currency is the local currency, are translated into United States dollars using period-end exchange rates. Revenues and expenses are translated at the average exchange rates in effect during each fiscal month during the year. The effects of foreign currency translation adjustments are included as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Foreign currency transaction (losses) gains included in other income (expense), net for fiscal 2013, 2012, and 2011 were $(0.5) million, $0.6 million, and $(1.1) million, respectively.
Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities
We utilize derivative instruments to hedge specific financial risks such as interest rate and foreign exchange risk. We do not engage in speculative hedging activity. In order for us to account for a derivative instrument as a hedge, specific criteria must be met, including: (i) ensuring at the inception of the hedge that formal documentation exists for both the hedging relationship and the entity’s risk management objective and strategy for undertaking the hedge and (ii) at the inception of the hedge and on an ongoing basis, the hedging relationship is expected to be highly effective in achieving offsetting changes in fair value attributed to the hedged risk during the period that the hedge is designated. Further, an assessment of effectiveness is required whenever financial statements or earnings are reported. Absent meeting these criteria, changes in fair value are recognized in other income (expense), net, in the consolidated statements of operations. Once the underlying forecasted transaction is realized, the gain or loss from the derivative designated as a hedge of the transaction is reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) to the statement of operations, in the appropriate revenue or expense caption. Any ineffective portion of the derivatives designated as cash flow hedges is recognized in current earnings. We report cash flows arising from derivative financial instruments designated as fair value or cash flow hedges consistent with the classification of the cash flows from the underlying hedged items that these derivatives are hedging. Cash flows from derivatives that do not qualify as hedges are generally reported in cash flows from investing activities. Cash payments or cash receipts on security price guarantees related to changes in the price of our own stock as discussed in Note 11, are reported as cash flows from financing activities.
Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation
We account for stock-based compensation to employees and directors, including grants of employee stock options, purchases under employee stock purchase plans, and restricted awards through recognition of the fair value of the share-based awards as a charge against earnings in the form of stock-based compensation. We recognize stock-based compensation expense over the requisite service period, net of estimated forfeitures. We recognize benefits from stock-based compensation in equity using the with-and-without approach for the utilization of tax attributes.

Net (Loss) Income Per Share
We compute net (loss) income per share in accordance with the two-class method. Under the two-class method, basic net income per share is computed by dividing the net income available to common stockholders by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period. Net losses are not allocated to preferred stockholders. We have determined that the Series B convertible preferred stock outstanding as of September 30, 2012 and 2011, represented a participating security and as such the preferred shares are excluded from basic earnings per share.
Diluted net (loss) income per share is computed using the more dilutive of (a) the two-class method, or (b) the if-converted method. We allocate net income first to preferred stockholders based on dividend rights and then to common and preferred stockholders based on ownership interests. The weighted-average number of common shares outstanding gives effect to all potentially dilutive common equivalent shares, including outstanding stock options and restricted stock, shares held in escrow, contingently issuable shares under earn-out agreements once earned, warrants, and potential issuance of stock upon conversion of our 2.75% Convertible Debentures. The convertible debentures are considered Instrument C securities due to the fact that only the excess of the conversion value on the date of conversion can be paid in our common shares; the principal portion of the conversion must be paid in cash. Therefore, only the shares of common stock potentially issuable with respect to the excess of the conversion value over its principal amount, if any, is considered as dilutive potential common shares for purposes of calculating diluted net (loss) income per share.

62

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





The following table sets forth the computation for basic and diluted net (loss) income per share for the years ended September 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011 (dollars in thousands, except per share amounts):
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Numerator:
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
 

 
 

 
 

Net (loss) income
$
(115,238
)
 
$
207,135

 
$
38,238

Allocation of undistributed earnings to preferred stockholders

 
(2,381
)
 
(445
)
Net (loss) income available to common stockholders — basic
$
(115,238
)
 
$
204,754

 
$
37,793

Diluted
 

 
 

 
 

Net (loss) income available to common stockholders — diluted
$
(115,238
)
 
$
207,135

 
$
38,238

Denominator:
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
 

 
 

 
 

Weighted average common shares outstanding
313,587

 
306,371

 
302,277

Diluted
 

 
 

 
 

Weighted average common shares outstanding — basic
313,587

 
306,371

 
302,277

Weighted average effect of dilutive common equivalent shares:
 

 
 

 
 

Assumed conversion of Series B Preferred Stock

 
3,562

 
3,562

Employee stock compensation plans

 
6,074

 
8,457

Warrants

 
2,094

 
1,499

Convertible Debt

 
2,558

 

Other contingently issuable shares

 
163

 
165

Weighted average common shares outstanding — diluted
313,587

 
320,822

 
315,960

Net (loss) income per share:
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
$
(0.37
)
 
$
0.67

 
$
0.13

Diluted
$
(0.37
)
 
$
0.65

 
$
0.12


Common equivalent shares are excluded from the computation of diluted net (loss) income per share if their effect is anti-dilutive. Potentially dilutive common equivalent shares aggregating to 13.6 million shares, 3.2 million shares and 3.2 million shares for the years ended September 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively, have been excluded from the computation of diluted net (loss) income per share because their inclusion would be anti-dilutive.

Recently Issued Accounting Standards
In July 2013, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued Accounting Standards Update No. 2013-11, "Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists" (ASU 2013-11) to provide guidance on the presentation of unrecognized tax benefits. ASU 2013-11 requires an entity to present an unrecognized tax benefit, or a portion of an unrecognized tax benefit, as a reduction to a deferred tax asset for a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward, except as follows: to the extent a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward is not available at the reporting date under the tax law of the applicable jurisdiction to settle any additional income taxes that would result from the disallowance of a tax position or the tax law of the applicable jurisdiction does not require the entity to use, and the entity does not intend to use, the deferred tax asset for such purpose, the unrecognized tax benefit should be presented in the financial statements as a liability and should not be combined with deferred tax assets. ASU 2013-11 is effective for us in our first quarter of fiscal 2015 with earlier adoption permitted. ASU 2013-11 should be applied prospectively with retroactive application permitted. We do not believe that this will have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.
In February 2013, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Accounting Standards Update No. 2013-02, “Reporting Amounts Reclassified Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income,” which amends Accounting Standards Codification 220, “Comprehensive Income.” The amended guidance requires entities to provide information about the amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income by component. Additionally, entities are required to present, either on the face of the financial statements or in the notes, significant amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income by the

63

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





respective line items of net income. The amended guidance does not change the current requirements for reporting net income or other comprehensive income. The amendment is effective prospectively for annual periods, and interim periods within those annual periods, beginning after December 15, 2012. We believe adoption of this new guidance will not have a material impact on our financial statements as these updates have an impact on presentation only.
3.
Business Acquisitions
Fiscal 2013 Acquisitions
On May 31, 2013, we acquired TGT for total consideration of $83.3 million in cash, including a purchase price adjustment as specified in the asset purchase agreement. TGT provides cloud-based infotainment and communications solutions to the automotive industry. The transaction was structured as an asset acquisition, and therefore the goodwill is expected to be deductible for tax purposes. The results of operations for TGT are included in our Mobile and Consumer segment from the acquisition date.
In October 2012, we acquired JA Thomas for cash consideration totaling approximately $244.8 million together with a deferred payment of $25.0 million contingent on the continued employment of certain key executives. The deferred payment will be recorded as compensation expense over the requisite employment period, and included in acquisition-related costs, net in our consolidated statements of operations. JA Thomas provides Clinical Documentation Improvement solutions to hospitals, primarily in the U.S., and the results of operations are included in our Healthcare segment from the acquisition date. In accordance with the JA Thomas stock purchase agreement, we reached an agreement with the sellers to treat this transaction as an asset purchase, and therefore the goodwill is expected to be deductible for tax purposes.
During fiscal 2013, we acquired several other businesses for total purchase consideration of $251.6 million. These acquisitions are not individually material and were made in each of our segments. These acquisitions are treated as stock purchases, and the goodwill resulting from these acquisitions is not expected to be deductible for tax purposes.
The results of operations of these acquisitions have been included in our financial results from the applicable acquisition date. A summary of the preliminary allocation of the purchase consideration for our fiscal 2013 acquisitions is as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
TGT
 
JA Thomas
 
Other Fiscal 2013 Acquisitions
Purchase consideration:
 
 
 
 
 
Cash
$
83,330

 
$
244,777

 
$
251,108

Fair value of contingent consideration

 

 
450

Total purchase consideration
$
83,330

 
$
244,777

 
$
251,558

 
 
 
 
 
 
Allocation of the purchase consideration:
 
 
 
 
 
Cash
$

 
$
3,555

 
$
18,004

Accounts receivable (a)
8,895

 
8,293

 
17,190

Goodwill
42,742

 
163,880

 
124,230

Identifiable intangible assets (b)
33,600

 
71,310

 
109,175

Other assets
10,330

 
2,935

 
29,150

Total assets acquired
95,567

 
249,973

 
297,749

Current liabilities
(1,452
)
 
(3,033
)
 
(9,788
)
Deferred tax liability

 
(1,474
)
 
(35,346
)
Other long term liabilities
(10,785
)
 
(689
)
 
(1,057
)
Total liabilities assumed
(12,237
)
 
(5,196
)
 
(46,191
)
Net assets acquired
$
83,330

 
$
244,777

 
$
251,558



64

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





(a)
Accounts receivable have been recorded at their estimated fair values and the fair value reserve was not material.

(b)
The following are the identifiable intangible assets acquired and their respective weighted average useful lives, as determined based on preliminary valuations (dollars in thousands):
 
TGT
 
JA Thomas
 
Other Fiscal 2013 Acquisitions
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Life
(Years)
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Life
(Years)
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Life
(Years)
Core and completed technology
$
7,700

 
7.0

 
$
3,920

 
5.0

 
$
33,653

 
6.6
Customer relationships
25,900

 
9.0

 
66,100

 
11.0

 
71,970

 
10.9
Trade names

 

 
1,290

 
7.0

 
3,122

 
6.6
Non-Compete agreements

 

 

 

 
430

 
2.8
Total
$
33,600

 
 
 
$
71,310

 
 
 
$
109,175

 
 
The fair value estimates for the assets acquired and liabilities assumed for acquisitions completed during fiscal 2013 were based upon preliminary calculations and valuations, and our estimates and assumptions for each of these acquisitions are subject to change as we obtain additional information during the respective measurement periods (up to one year from the respective acquisition dates). The primary areas of preliminary estimates that were not yet finalized related to certain receivables and liabilities acquired and identifiable intangible assets.

Fiscal 2012 Acquisitions
On June 1, 2012, we acquired all of the outstanding capital stock of Vlingo for net cash consideration of $196.3 million, which excludes the amounts we received as a security holder of Vlingo, as described below. Vlingo provides technology that turns spoken words into action by combining speech recognition and natural language processing technology to understand the user's intent and take the appropriate action. The acquisition is treated as a stock purchase for accounting purposes, and the goodwill resulting from this acquisition is not expected to be deductible for tax purposes. The results of operations for Vlingo are included in our Mobile and Consumer Segment from the acquisition date.
On April 26, 2012, we acquired all of the outstanding capital stock of Transcend, a provider of medical transcription and editing services. The aggregate consideration payable to the former stockholders of Transcend was $332.3 million. The acquisition is treated as a stock purchase for accounting purposes, and the goodwill resulting from this acquisition is not expected to be deductible for tax purposes. The results of operations for Transcend are included in our Healthcare segment from the acquisition date.
During fiscal 2012, we acquired three additional businesses for total cash consideration of $355.6 million. The most significant of these other acquisitions was Quantim, for which we paid total consideration of $230.2 million, and is included in our Healthcare segment. The results of operations of these acquisitions have been included in our consolidated results from their respective acquisition dates. The goodwill resulting from these transactions is not expected to be deductible for tax purposes.


65

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





A summary of the final allocation of the purchase consideration for Vlingo, Transcend and our other fiscal 2012 acquisitions is as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
Vlingo
 
Transcend
 
Other Fiscal 2012 Acquisitions
Purchase consideration:
 

 
 

 
 
Cash
$
196,304

 
$
332,253

 
$
339,194

Fair value of contingent consideration

 

 
16,444

Fair value of prior investment (a)
28,696

 

 

Total purchase consideration
$
225,000

 
$
332,253

 
$
355,638

Allocation of the purchase consideration:
 

 
 

 
 
Cash
$

 
$
6,255

 
$
10,194

Accounts receivable(b)
5,904

 
16,766

 
51,564

Goodwill (c)
189,420

 
214,209

 
208,102

Identifiable intangible assets(d)
29,382

 
142,160

 
144,900

Other assets
6,274

 
17,714

 
9,707

Total assets acquired
230,980

 
397,104

 
424,467

Current liabilities
(5,980
)
 
(21,583
)
 
(8,544
)
Deferred tax liability

 
(41,000
)
 
(57,247
)
Other long term liabilities

 
(2,268
)
 
(3,038
)
Total liabilities assumed
(5,980
)
 
(64,851
)
 
(68,829
)
Net assets acquired
$
225,000

 
$
332,253

 
$
355,638



(a)
In October 2009, we acquired $15.0 million of convertible preferred securities of Vlingo. We have recognized a gain of $13.7 million included in other (expense) income, net, in year ended September 30, 2012, reflecting the fair value adjustment as a result of the conversion of our original investment in the non-controlling interest upon the closing of the Vlingo acquisition.

(b)
Accounts receivable have been recorded at their estimated fair values, which consists of the gross accounts receivable assumed of $88.0 million, reduced by a fair value reserve of $13.8 million representing the portion of contractually owed accounts receivable which we do not expect to be collected.

(c)
At the time of the Vlingo acquisition, we ascribed significant value to future new customer relationships, future technologies that could be developed, as well as synergies and other benefits that do not meet the recognition criteria of acquired identifiable intangible assets. Accordingly, the value of these components is included within goodwill.

(d)
The following are the identifiable intangible assets acquired and their respective weighted average useful lives, as determined based on final valuations (dollars in thousands):
 
Vlingo
 
Transcend
 
Other Fiscal 2012 Acquisitions
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Life
(Years)
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Life
(Years)
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Life
(Years)
Core and completed technology
$
5,362

 
5.4
 
$
5,410

 
5.0
 
$
45,300

 
7.9
Customer relationships
23,200

 
14.0
 
130,260

 
13.0
 
90,400

 
11.5
Trade name
30

 
1.0
 
4,480

 
4.0
 
9,000

 
8.2
Non-Compete agreements
790

 
3.0
 
2,010

 
3.0
 
200

 
3.0
Total
$
29,382

 
 
 
$
142,160

 
 
 
$
144,900

 
 


66

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





Fiscal 2011 Acquisitions
On June 16, 2011, we acquired all of the outstanding capital stock of SVOX, a Swiss based seller of speech recognition, dialog, and text-to-speech software products for the automotive, mobile and consumer electronics industries in our Mobile and Consumer segment. Total purchase consideration was €87.0 million which consists of cash consideration of €57.0 million ($80.9 million based on the exchange rate as of the date of acquisition) and aggregate deferred acquisition payments of €30.0 million ($41.5 million based on the exchange rate as of the date of acquisition). The deferred acquisition payment is payable in cash or shares of our common stock, at our option; €8.3 million of the deferred acquisition payment was paid in cash in June 2012 and the remaining cash payment of €21.7 million was made in December 2012. The acquisition is treated as a stock purchase for accounting purposes, and the goodwill resulting from this acquisition is not expected to be deductible for tax purposes. The results of operations of SVOX have been included in our results of operations from the acquisition date.

On June 15, 2011, we acquired all of the outstanding capital stock of Equitrac, a leading provider of print management solutions, to expand the offerings of our Imaging segment, for cash consideration of approximately $162.0 million. The acquisition is treated as a stock purchase for accounting purposes, and the goodwill resulting from this acquisition is not expected to be deductible for tax purposes. The results of operations of Equitrac have been included in our results of operations from the acquisition date.
A summary of the final allocation of the purchase consideration for Equitrac and SVOX is as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
Equitrac
 
SVOX
Purchase consideration:
 

 
 

Cash
$
161,950

 
$
80,919

Deferred acquisition payment

 
41,456

Total purchase consideration
$
161,950

 
$
122,375

Allocation of the purchase consideration:
 

 
 

Cash
$
115

 
$

Accounts receivable(a)
9,931

 
3,663

Inventory
2,462

 

Goodwill
90,077

 
86,767

Identifiable intangible assets(b)
91,900

 
42,165

Other assets
12,144

 
2,728

Total assets acquired
206,629

 
135,323

Current liabilities
(6,368
)
 
(9,663
)
Deferred tax liability
(38,311
)
 
(3,285
)
Total liabilities assumed
(44,679
)
 
(12,948
)
Net assets acquired
$
161,950

 
$
122,375

_______________________________________
(a)
Accounts receivable have been recorded at their estimated fair values, which consists of the gross accounts receivable assumed of $15.4 million, reduced by a fair value reserve of $1.8 million representing the portion of contractually owed accounts receivable which we do not expect to be collected.
(b)
The following are the identifiable intangible assets acquired and their respective weighted average useful lives, as determined based on final valuations (dollars in thousands):
 
Equitrac
 
SVOX
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Life (Years)
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Life (Years)
Customer relationships
$
55,800

 
15.0
 
$
35,612

 
13.4
Core and completed technology
22,000

 
7.0
 
6,268

 
5.0
Trade name
14,100

 
10.0
 
285

 
3.0
Total
$
91,900

 
 
 
$
42,165

 
 

67

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)






Other Fiscal 2011 Acquisitions
During fiscal 2011, we acquired three additional businesses, primarily to expand our product offerings and enhance our technology base. The results of operations of these acquisitions have been included in our consolidated results from their respective acquisition dates. The total consideration for these acquisitions was $157.1 million, paid in cash. In allocating the total purchase consideration for these acquisitions based on estimated fair values, we recorded $94.4 million of goodwill and $57.8 million of identifiable intangible assets. Intangible assets acquired included primarily customer relationships and core and completed technology with weighted average useful lives of 12.4 years. The goodwill resulting from these transactions is not expected to be deductible for tax purposes.
4.
Pro Forma Results (Unaudited)
The following table shows unaudited pro forma results of operations as if we had acquired TGT, Vlingo, and Transcend on October 1, 2011 (dollars in thousands, except per share amounts):
 
2013
 
2012
Revenue
$
1,862,132

 
$
1,737,501

Net (loss) income
$
(131,630
)
 
$
193,742

Net (loss) income per share (diluted)
$
(0.42
)
 
$
0.60


We have not furnished pro forma financial information relating to our other fiscal 2013 and 2012 acquisitions because such information is not material, individually or in the aggregate, to our financial results. The unaudited pro forma results of operations are not necessarily indicative of the actual results that would have occurred had the transactions actually taken place at the beginning of the periods indicated.

5.
Contingent Acquisition Payments

Earn-out Payments
The fair value of any contingent consideration is established at the acquisition date and included in the total purchase price. The contingent consideration is then adjusted to fair value as an increase or decrease in current earnings in each reporting period.
In connection with our acquisition of JA Thomas in October 2012, we agreed to make deferred payments to the former shareholders of JA Thomas of up to $25.0 million, payable in cash or shares of our common stock, at our option. The payment is due in October 2014 and is contingent upon the continued employment of certain named executives and certain other conditions. The contingent payments will be reduced by amounts specified in the merger agreement in the event that any of the named executives terminates their employment prior to the payment date. The portion of the deferred payment that is payable to the named executives will be recognized as compensation expense over the two year employment period and included in acquisition-related costs, net in our consolidated statements of operations.
In connection with our acquisition of Swype, Inc. ("Swype") in October 2011, we agreed to make deferred payments to the former shareholders of Swype of up to $25.0 million in April 2013, contingent upon the continued employment of three named executives and certain other conditions. The contingent payments were subject to reduction by amounts specified in the merger agreement in the event that any of the three executives terminated employment prior to the payment date or if any losses occurred to which we would be entitled to indemnification under the merger agreement. The portion of the deferred payment that was payable to the three named executives was recognized as compensation expense over the 18 month employment period and included in acquisition-related costs, net, in our consolidated statements of operations. The remaining liability due to the other shareholders was included in the total purchase consideration and was recorded at its estimated fair value at the acquisition date of $16.4 million. In April 2013, upon completion of the required employment condition, we made a cash payment of $25.0 million to the former shareholders of Swype.

68

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





6.
Goodwill and Intangible Assets
The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill for our reportable segments for fiscal years 2013 and 2012 were as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
Healthcare
 
Mobile and Consumer
 
Enterprise
 
Imaging
 
Total
Balance as of September 30, 2011
$
672,649

 
$
1,018,415

 
$
500,240

 
$
156,576

 
$
2,347,880

Acquisitions
354,795

 
252,192

 

 
8,906

 
615,893

Purchase accounting adjustments

 
(2,265
)
 
(1,042
)
 
2,638

 
(669
)
Effect of foreign currency translation
(2,776
)
 
(2,476
)
 
(2,365
)
 
(10
)
 
(7,627
)
Balance as of September 30, 2012
$
1,024,668

 
$
1,265,866

 
$
496,833

 
$
168,110

 
$
2,955,477

Acquisitions
232,545

 
47,597

 
17,372

 
33,338

 
330,852

Dispositions
(712
)
 

 
(731
)
 

 
(1,443
)
Purchase accounting adjustments
(588
)
 
(3,829
)
 

 
265

 
(4,152
)
Effect of foreign currency translation
1,314

 
4,001

 
6,495

 
654

 
12,464

Balance as of September 30, 2013
$
1,257,227

 
$
1,313,635

 
$
519,969

 
$
202,367

 
$
3,293,198


Intangible assets consist of the following as of September 30, 2013 and 2012, which includes $98.8 million and $108.8 million of licensed technology, respectively (dollars in thousands):
 
September 30, 2013
 
Gross Carrying Amount
 
Accumulated Amortization
 
Net Carrying Amount
 
Weighted Average Remaining Life (Years)
Customer relationships
$
1,072,993

 
$
(423,442
)
 
$
649,551

 
9.4
Technology and patents
445,331

 
(188,585
)
 
256,746

 
5.3
Trade names, trademarks, and other
63,651

 
(18,661
)
 
44,990

 
8.3
Non-competition agreements
3,981

 
(1,990
)
 
1,991

 
1.5
Total
$
1,585,956

 
$
(632,678
)
 
$
953,278

 
8.2

 
September 30, 2012
 
Gross Carrying Amount
 
Accumulated Amortization
 
Net Carrying Amount
 
Weighted Average Remaining Life (Years)
Customer relationships
$
957,043

 
$
(364,161
)
 
$
592,882

 
9.7
Technology and patents
461,356

 
(198,689
)
 
262,667

 
5.8
Trade names, trademarks, and other
60,080

 
(12,239
)
 
47,841

 
9.1
Non-competition agreements
5,144

 
(1,996
)
 
3,148

 
2.4
Total
$
1,483,623

 
$
(577,085
)
 
$
906,538

 
8.5

Amortization expense for acquired technology and patents is included in the cost of revenue from amortization of intangible assets in the accompanying statements of operations and amounted to $63.6 million, $60.0 million and $55.1 million in fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. Amortization expense for customer relationships, trade names, trademarks, and other, and non-competition agreements is included in operating expenses and amounted to $105.3 million, $95.4 million and $88.2 million in fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

69

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





Estimated amortization expense for each of the five succeeding years as of September 30, 2013, is as follows (dollars in thousands):
Year Ending September 30,
 
Cost of Revenue
 
Other Operating Expenses
 
Total
2014
 
$
57,714

 
$
104,143

 
$
161,857

2015
 
53,927

 
97,028

 
150,955

2016
 
47,644

 
87,048

 
134,692

2017
 
38,610

 
74,368

 
112,978

2018
 
27,899

 
55,736

 
83,635

Thereafter
 
30,952

 
278,209

 
309,161

Total
 
$
256,746

 
$
696,532

 
$
953,278


7.
Accounts Receivable
Accounts receivable consisted of the following (dollars in thousands):
 
September 30, 2013
 
September 30, 2012
Trade accounts receivable
$
375,044

 
$
369,585

Unbilled accounts receivable under long-term contracts
21,886

 
28,633

Gross accounts receivable
396,930

 
398,218

Less — allowance for doubtful accounts
(8,529
)
 
(6,933
)
Less — allowance for sales returns
(5,660
)
 
(9,868
)
Accounts receivable, net
$
382,741

 
$
381,417


8.
Land, Building and Equipment, Net
Land, building and equipment, net consisted of the following (dollars in thousands):
 
Useful Life
 
September 30, 2013
 
September 30, 2012
 
(In years)
 
 
 
 
Land

 
$
2,400

 
$
2,400

Building
30

 
5,456

 
5,456

Machinery and equipment
3-5

 
59,941

 
37,706

Computers, software and equipment
3-5

 
210,647

 
173,022

Leasehold improvements
2-7

 
26,357

 
21,963

Furniture and fixtures
5

 
14,862

 
12,995

Construction in progress

 
1,945

 
1,649

Subtotal
 

 
321,608

 
255,191

Less: accumulated depreciation
 

 
(178,143
)
 
(139,057
)
Land, building and equipment, net
 

 
$
143,465

 
$
116,134

Depreciation expense for fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011 was $39.8 million, $31.7 million and $27.6 million, respectively.


70

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





9.
Accrued Expenses and Other Current Liabilities
Accrued expenses and other current liabilities consisted of the following (dollars in thousands):
 
September 30, 2013
 
September 30, 2012
Compensation
$
112,756

 
$
125,180

Cost of revenue related liabilities
17,992

 
12,050

Professional fees
17,682

 
12,799

Accrued interest payable
15,879

 
13,859

Acquisition costs and liabilities
15,722

 
17,258

Sales and marketing incentives
11,681

 
10,795

Sales and other taxes payable
10,625

 
8,364

Other
12,088

 
14,873

Total
$
214,425

 
$
215,178


10.
Credit Facilities and Debt
At September 30, 2013 and 2012, we had the following borrowing obligations (dollars in thousands):
 
September 30, 2013
 
September 30, 2012
5.375% Senior Notes due 2020, net of unamortized premium of $5.4 million at September 30, 2013
$
1,055,385

 
$
700,000

2.75% Convertible Debentures due 2031, net of unamortized discount of $113.5 million and $136.4 million, respectively
576,524

 
553,587

2.75% Convertible Debentures due 2027, net of unamortized discount of $8.8 million and $18.4 million, respectively
241,206

 
231,552

Credit Facility, net of unamortized original issue discount of $1.2 million at September 30, 2013
481,016

 
630,596

Other

 
170

Total long-term debt
2,354,131

 
2,115,905

Less: current portion
246,040

 
380,094

Non-current portion of long-term debt
$
2,108,091

 
$
1,735,811


The estimated fair value of our long-term debt approximated $2,458.2 million (face value $2,472.2 million) and $2,522.2 million (face value $2,270.7 million) at September 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively. These fair value amounts represent the value at which our lenders could trade our debt within the financial markets, and do not represent the settlement value of these long-term debt liabilities to us at each reporting date. The fair value of the long-term debt will continue to vary each period based on fluctuations in market interest rates, as well as changes to our credit ratings. The Senior Notes, the Convertible Debentures, and the term loan portion of our Credit Facility are traded and the fair values are based upon traded prices as of the reporting dates. The fair values of each borrowing was estimated using the averages of the bid and ask trading quotes at each respective date. We had no outstanding balance on the revolving credit line portion of our Credit Facility at September 30, 2013 and 2012.
5.375% Senior Notes due 2020
On October 22, 2012, we issued an additional $350.0 million aggregate principal amount of our 5.375% Senior notes due 2020 (the "Notes"). The Notes were issued pursuant to an indenture agreement dated August 14, 2012, relating to our existing $700 million aggregate principal amount of 5.375% Senior Notes due in 2020, issued in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2012. Total proceeds received, net of issuance costs, were $351.7 million. On October 31, 2012, we used $143.5 million of the net proceeds to pay the term loans under the Credit Facility originally maturing in March 2013.
On August 14, 2012, we issued $700 million aggregate principal amount of 5.375% Senior Notes due on August 15, 2020 in a private placement. The net proceeds from the Notes were approximately $689.1 million, net of issuance costs. The Notes bear interest at 5.375% per year, payable in cash semi-annually in arrears. The ending unamortized deferred debt issuance costs

71

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





for the total 5.375% Senior Notes at September 30, 2013 and 2012 were $13.0 million and $12.1 million respectively.
The Notes are the unsecured senior obligations of the Company and are guaranteed (the “Guarantees”) on an unsecured senior basis by substantially all of the Company's direct and indirect wholly owned domestic subsidiaries (the “Subsidiary Guarantors”). The Notes and Guarantees rank equally in right of payment with all of the Company's and the Subsidiary Guarantors' existing and future unsecured senior debt and rank senior in right of payment to all of the Company's and the Subsidiary Guarantors' future unsecured subordinated debt. The Notes and Guarantees effectively rank junior to all secured debt of the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors to the extent of the value of the collateral securing such debt and to all liabilities, including trade payables, of the Company's subsidiaries that have not guaranteed the Notes.
At any time before August 15, 2016, we may redeem all or a portion of the Notes at a redemption price equal to 100% of the aggregate principal amount of the Notes to be redeemed, plus a “make-whole” premium and accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date. At any time on or after August 15, 2016, we may redeem all or a portion of the Notes at certain redemption prices expressed as percentages of the principal amount, plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date. At any time and from time to time before August 15, 2015, we may redeem up to 35% of the aggregate outstanding principal amount of the Notes with the net cash proceeds received by the Company from certain equity offerings at a price equal to 105.375%, plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date, provided that the redemption occurs no later than the 120 days after the closing of the related equity offering, and at least 50% of the original aggregate principal amount of the Notes remains outstanding immediately thereafter.
Upon the occurrence of certain asset sales or a change in control, we must offer to repurchase the Notes at a price equal to 100%, in the case of an asset sale, or 101%, in the case of a change of control, of the principal amount plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the repurchase date.
2.75% Convertible Debentures due 2031
On October 24, 2011, we sold $690 million of 2.75% Convertible Debentures due in 2031 (the “2031 Debentures”) in a private placement. Total proceeds, net of debt issuance costs, were $676.1 million. The 2031 Debentures bear interest at 2.75% per year, payable in cash semi-annually in arrears. The 2031 Debentures mature on November 1, 2031, subject to the right of the holders to require us to redeem the 2031 Debentures on November 1, 2017, 2021, and 2026.
ASC 470-20, Debt with Conversion and Other Options, requires us to allocate the proceeds to the liability component based on the fair value determined at the issuance date with the remainder allocated to the conversion right and recorded in stockholders' equity. We initially allocated $533.6 million to long-term debt, and $156.4 million has been recorded as additional paid-in capital. The aggregate debt discount is being amortized to interest expense using the effective interest rate method through November 2017. As of September 30, 2013 and 2012, the ending unamortized discount was $113.5 million and 136.4 million, respectively and the ending unamortized deferred debt issuance costs were $7.3 million and $9.1 million, respectively. The 2031 Debentures are general senior unsecured obligations and rank equally in right of payment with all of our existing and future unsecured, unsubordinated indebtedness and senior in right of payment to any indebtedness that is contractually subordinated to the 2031 Debentures. The 2031 Debentures will be effectively subordinated to indebtedness and other liabilities of our subsidiaries.
If converted, the principal amount of the 2031 Debentures is payable in cash and any amounts payable in excess of the principal amount will (based on an initial conversion rate, which represents an initial conversion price of approximately $32.30 per share, subject to adjustment) be paid in cash or shares of our common stock, at our election, only in the following circumstances and to the following extent: (i) on any date during any fiscal quarter (and only during such fiscal quarter) if the closing sale price of our common stock was more than 130% of the then current conversion price for at least 20 trading days in the period of the 30 consecutive trading days ending on the last trading day of the previous fiscal quarter; (ii) during the five consecutive business-day period following any five consecutive trading-day period in which the trading price for $1,000 principal amount of the 2031 Debentures for each day during such five trading-day period was less than 98% of the closing sale price of our common stock multiplied by the then current conversion rate; (iii) upon the occurrence of specified corporate transactions, as described in the indenture for the 2031 Debentures; or (iv) at the option of the holder at any time on or after May 1, 2031. Additionally, we may redeem the 2031 Debentures, in whole or in part, on or after November 6, 2017 at par plus accrued and unpaid interest. Each holder shall have the right, at such holder's option, to require us to repurchase all or any portion of the 2031 Debentures held by such holder on November 1, 2017November 1, 2021, and November 1, 2026 at par plus accrued and unpaid interest. If we undergo a fundamental change (as described in the indenture for the 2031 Debentures) prior to maturity, holders will have the option to require us to repurchase all or any portion of their debentures for cash at a price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the debentures to be purchased plus any accrued and unpaid interest, including any additional interest to, but excluding, the repurchase date. As of September 30, 2013, no conversion triggers were met. If the conversion triggers were met, we could be required to repay all or some of the aggregate principal amount in cash prior to the maturity date.

72

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)






2.75% Convertible Debentures due 2027
On August 13, 2007, we issued $250 million of 2.75% convertible senior debentures due in 2027 (“the 2027 Debentures”) in a private placement. Total proceeds, net of debt discount and deferred debt issuance costs were $241.4 million. The 2027 Debentures bear an interest rate of 2.75% per annum, payable semi-annually in arrears, and mature on August 15, 2027 subject to the right of the holders of the 2027 Debentures to require us to redeem the 2027 Debentures on August 15, 2014, 2017 and 2022. In accordance with ASC 470-20, Debt with Conversion and Other Options, the difference of $54.7 million between the fair value of the liability component of the 2027 Debentures and the net proceeds on the date of issuance have been recorded as additional paid-in-capital and as debt discount. The aggregate debt discount is being amortized to interest expense using the effective interest rate method through August 2014. As of September 30, 2013 and 2012, the ending unamortized discount was $8.8 million and $18.4 million, respectively, and the ending unamortized deferred debt issuance costs were $0.8 million and $1.7 million, respectively. The 2027 Debentures are general senior unsecured obligations, ranking equally in right of payment to all of our existing and future unsecured, unsubordinated indebtedness and senior in right of payment to any indebtedness that is contractually subordinated to the 2027 Debentures. The 2027 Debentures are effectively subordinated to our secured indebtedness to the extent of the value of the collateral securing such indebtedness and are structurally subordinated to indebtedness and other liabilities of our subsidiaries.
If converted, the principal amount of the 2027 Debentures is payable in cash and any amounts payable in excess of the principal amount will (based on an initial conversion rate, which represents an initial conversion price of $19.47 per share, subject to adjustment) be paid in cash or shares of our common stock, at our election, only in the following circumstances and to the following extent: (i) on any date during any fiscal quarter (and only during such fiscal quarter) if the closing sale price of our common stock was more than 120% of the then current conversion price for at least 20 trading days in the period of the 30 consecutive trading days ending on the last trading day of the previous fiscal quarter; (ii) during the five consecutive business-day period following any five consecutive trading-day period in which the trading price for $1,000 principal amount of the Debentures for each day during such five trading-day period was less than 98% of the closing sale price of our common stock multiplied by the then current conversion rate; (iii) upon the occurrence of specified corporate transactions, as described in the indenture for the 2027 Debentures; and (iv) at the option of the holder at any time on or after February 15, 2027. Additionally, we may redeem the 2027 Debentures, in whole or in part, on or after August 20, 2014 at par plus accrued and unpaid interest; each holder shall have the right, at such holder’s option, to require us to repurchase all or any portion of the 2027 Debentures held by such holder on August 15, 2014, August 15, 2017 and August 15, 2022. If we undergo a fundamental change (as described in the indenture for the 2027 Debentures) prior to maturity, holders will have the option to require us to repurchase all or any portion of their debentures for cash at a price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the debentures to be purchased plus any accrued and unpaid interest, including any additional interest to, but excluding, the repurchase date.
The 2027 Debentures are puttable at the holders option in August 2014. As a result, we have classified the obligation in current liabilities at September 30, 2013. Our stock price exceeded the conversion threshold price of $23.36 per share for at least 20 days during the 30 consecutive trading days ended September 30, 2012. Accordingly, the 2027 Debentures were convertible at the holders' option during the quarter ended December 31, 2012 and therefore were classified as current liabilities at September 30, 2012.
The difference between the carrying value of the 2027 Debentures and the $250.0 million principal amount reflects the unamortized portion of the original issue discount recognized upon issuance of the notes, which is being amortized over the expected term of the convertible debt. Because the 2027 Debentures were convertible at September 30, 2012 at the holders option, an amount equal to the $18.4 million unamortized portion of the original issue discount was separately classified in our consolidated balance sheets as temporary equity and referred to as “Equity component of currently redeemable convertible debentures.” At September 30, 2013, we have no temporary equity.
Credit Facility
On August 7, 2013, we entered into an amendment agreement to amend and restate our existing amended and restated credit agreement, as previously amended. The credit agreement was originally dated March 31, 2006, and was amended and restated on April 5, 2007, and further amended and restated on July 7, 2011. The amended credit agreement includes a term loan and a $75 million revolving credit line including letters of credit (together, the "Credit Facility"). Of the $483.4 million outstanding term loans originally due March 31, 2016, existing Lenders representing $333.2 million elected to extend the maturity to August 7, 2019 and the balance of the term loans have been assigned to new lenders who have also agreed to the extended maturity date. We accounted for the amendment in accordance with ASC 470-50-40, "Debt - Modifications and Extinguishments”and determined that the amendment should be accounted for as an extinguishment for certain of the lenders participating in the credit facility,

73

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





based on the new terms of the amended agreement. Of the total balance outstanding at the amendment date, $277.1 million was recorded as extinguished, and the loss on extinguishment was not material.
The extended term loans bear interest, at our option, at a base rate determined in accordance with the amended and restated credit agreement, plus a spread of 1.75%, or a LIBOR rate plus a spread of 2.75%. Also, under terms of the amendment, the maturity date of our $75 million credit facility has been extended from March 31, 2015 to August 7, 2018. The extended revolving loans bear interest, at our option, at a base rate determined in accordance with the Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, plus a spread of 0.50% to 0.75%, or a LIBOR rate plus a spread of 1.50% to 1.75%, in each case determined based on our consolidated net leverage ratio. As of September 30, 2013, there were $6.5 million of letters of credit issued under the revolving credit line and there were no other outstanding borrowings under the revolving credit line.
Under terms of the amended Credit Facility, interest is payable monthly at a rate equal to the applicable margin plus, at our option, either (a) the base rate which is the corporate base rate of Morgan Stanley, the Administrative Agent, or (b) LIBOR (equal to (i) the British Bankers’ Association Interest Settlement Rates for deposits in U.S. dollars divided by (ii) one minus the statutory reserves applicable to such borrowing). The applicable margin for the borrowings is as follows:
Description
 
Base Rate Margin
 
LIBOR Margin
Term loans maturing August 2019
 
1.75%
 
2.75%
Revolving facility due August 2018
 
0.50% - 0.75% (a)
 
1.50% - 1.75% (a)
(a)
The margin is determined based on our net leverage ratio at the date the interest rates are reset on the revolving credit line.
At September 30, 2013 the applicable margins were 1.75%, with an effective rate of 2.94%, on the remaining balance of $482.2 million maturing in August 2019. We are required to pay a commitment fee for unutilized commitments under the revolving credit facility at a rate ranging from 0.375% to 0.50% per annum, based upon our leverage ratio. As of September 30, 2013, the commitment fee rate was 0.375%.

We capitalized debt issuance costs related to the Credit Facility and are amortizing the costs to interest expense using the effective interest rate method, through August 2018 for costs associated with the revolving credit facility and through August 2019 for the remainder of the balance. As of September 30, 2013 and 2012, the ending unamortized deferred financing fees were $2.9 million and $4.1 million, respectively.
Principal payments on the term loan of $482.2 million are due in quarterly installments of $1.2 million through August 2019, at which point the remaining balance becomes due. In addition, an annual excess cash flow sweep, as defined in the Credit Facility, is payable in the first quarter of each fiscal year, based on the excess cash flow generated in the previous fiscal year. We have not generated excess cash flows in any period and no additional payments are required. We will continue to evaluate the extent to which a payment is due in the first quarter of future fiscal years based on excess cash flow generation. At the current time, we are unable to predict the amount of the outstanding principal, if any, that may be required to be repaid in future fiscal years pursuant to the excess cash flow sweep provisions. Any term loan borrowings not paid through the baseline repayment, the excess cash flow sweep, or any other mandatory or optional payments that we may make, will be repaid upon maturity. If only the baseline repayments are made, the annual aggregate principal amount of the term loans repaid would be as follows (dollars in thousands):
Year Ending September 30,
 
Amount
2014
 
$
4,834

2015
 
4,834

2016
 
4,834

2017
 
4,834

2018
 
4,834

Thereafter
 
458,040

Total
 
$
482,210


Our obligations under the Credit Facility are unconditionally guaranteed by, subject to certain exceptions, each of our existing and future direct and indirect wholly-owned domestic subsidiaries. The Credit Facility and the guarantees thereof are secured by first priority liens and security interests in the following: 100% of the capital stock of substantially all of our domestic subsidiaries

74

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





and 65% of the outstanding voting equity interests and 100% of the non-voting equity interests of first-tier foreign subsidiaries, all our material tangible and intangible assets and those of the guarantors, and any present and future intercompany debt. The Credit Facility also contains provisions for mandatory prepayments of outstanding term loans upon receipt of the following, and subject to certain exceptions: 100% of net cash proceeds from asset sales, 100% of net cash proceeds from issuance or incurrence of debt, and 100% of extraordinary receipts. We may voluntarily prepay borrowings under the Credit Facility without premium or penalty other than breakage costs, as defined with respect to LIBOR-based loans.

11.
Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities
Derivatives not Designated as Hedges
Forward Currency Contracts
We operate our business in countries throughout the world and transact business in various foreign currencies. Our foreign currency exposures typically arise from transactions denominated in currencies other than the local functional currency of our operations. We have a hedging program that primarily utilizes foreign currency forward contracts to offset these risks associated with the effect of certain foreign currency exposures. Our program is designed so that increases or decreases in our foreign currency exposures are offset by gains or losses on the foreign currency forward contracts in order to mitigate the risks and volatility associated with our foreign currency transactions. Generally, we enter into contracts for less than 90 days, and at September 30, 2013 and 2012, we had outstanding contracts with a total notional value of $247.8 million and $83.9 million, respectively.

We have not designated these forward contracts as hedging instruments pursuant to ASC 815, Derivatives and Hedging and accordingly, we recorded the fair value of these contracts at the end of each reporting period in our consolidated balance sheet, with changes in the fair value recorded in earnings as other income (expense), net in our consolidated statement of operations. During the years ended September 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011, we recorded gains (losses) of $2.2 million, $(2.3) million and $(2.3) million, respectively, associated with these contracts.
Security Price Guarantees
From time to time we enter into agreements that allow us to issue shares of our common stock as part or all of the consideration related to partnering and technology acquisition activities. Generally these shares are issued subject to security price guarantees which are accounted for as derivatives. We have determined that these instruments would not be considered equity instruments if they were freestanding. The security price guarantees require payment from either us to a third party, or from a third party to us, based upon the difference between the price of our common stock on the issue date and an average price of our common stock approximately six months following the issue date. Changes in the fair value of these security price guarantees are reported in earnings in each period as other income (expense), net. During the years ended September 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011, we recorded $(6.6) million, $8.0 million and $13.2 million, respectively of (losses) gains associated with these contracts and (paid) received cash totaling $(3.8) million, $9.0 million and $9.4 million, respectively, upon the settlement of agreements during the year.

The following is a summary of the outstanding shares subject to security price guarantees at September 30, 2013 (dollars in thousands):
Issue Date
 
Number of Shares Issued
 
Settlement Date
 
Total Value of Shares on Issue Date
June 1, 2013
 
193,699

 
December 1, 2013
 
$
3,750

August 15, 2013
 
934,960

 
February 15, 2014
 
$
18,400


75

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)






The following table provides a quantitative summary of the fair value of our derivative instruments as of September 30, 2013 and 2012 (dollars in thousands):
 
 
 
 
Fair Value
Description
 
Balance Sheet Classification
 
September 30, 2013
 
September 30, 2012
Derivatives Not Designated as Hedges:
 
 
 
 

 
 

Foreign currency contracts
 
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
 
$
2,201

 
$
1,047

Security Price Guarantees
 
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
 

 
1,758

Security Price Guarantees
 
Accrued expenses and other current liabilities
 
(1,044
)
 

Net asset value of non-hedged derivative instruments
 
 
 
$
1,157

 
$
2,805


The following tables summarize the activity of derivative instruments for the fiscal 2013 and 2012 (dollars in thousands):
Derivatives Not Designated as Hedges for the Fiscal Year Ended September 30
 
Location of Gain (Loss) Recognized in Income
 
Amount of Gain (Loss) Recognized in Income
 
 
2013
 
2012
Foreign currency contracts
Other income, net
 
$
2,182

 
$
(2,324
)
Security price guarantees
Other income, net
 
$
(6,603
)
 
$
7,997


12.
Fair Value Measures
Fair value is defined as the price that would be received for an asset, or paid to transfer a liability, in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. Valuation techniques must maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs. When determining the fair value measurements for assets and liabilities required to be recorded at fair value, we consider the principal or most advantageous market in which we would transact and consider assumptions that market participants would use when pricing the asset or liability, such as inherent risk, transfer restrictions, and risk of nonperformance.

ASC 820, Fair Value Measures and Disclosures, establishes a value hierarchy based on three levels of inputs, of which the first two are considered observable and the third is considered unobservable:

Level 1.  Quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in active markets which we can access.
Level 2.  Observable inputs other than those described as Level 1.
Level 3.  Unobservable inputs.


76

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





Assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis at September 30, 2013 and 2012 consisted of (dollars in thousands):
 
September 30, 2013
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Total
Assets:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Money market funds(a)
$
684,697

 
$

 
$

 
$
684,697

US government agency securities(a)
1,000

 

 

 
1,000

Marketable securities, $38,728 at cost (b)

 
38,728

 

 
38,728

Foreign currency exchange contracts(b)

 
2,201

 

 
2,201

Total assets at fair value
$
685,697

 
$
40,929

 
$

 
$
726,626

Liabilities:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Security price guarantees(c)

 
(1,044
)
 

 
(1,044
)
Contingent earn-out(d)

 

 
(450
)
 
(450
)
Total liabilities at fair value
$

 
$
(1,044
)
 
$
(450
)
 
$
(1,494
)

 
September 30, 2012
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Total
Assets:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Money market funds(a)
$
971,091

 
$

 
$

 
$
971,091

Time deposits(b)

 
39,344

 

 
39,344

US government agency securities(a)
1,000

 

 

 
1,000

Foreign currency exchange contracts(b)

 
1,047

 

 
1,047

Security price guarantees(c)

 
1,758

 

 
1,758

Total assets at fair value
$
972,091

 
$
42,149

 
$

 
$
1,014,240

Liabilities:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Contingent earn-out(d)

 

 
(16,980
)
 
(16,980
)
Total liabilities at fair value
$

 
$

 
$
(16,980
)
 
$
(16,980
)

(a)
Money market funds and US government agency securities, included in cash and cash equivalents in the accompanying balance sheet, are valued at quoted market prices in active markets.
(b)
The fair value of our time deposits, marketable securities and foreign currency exchange contracts is based on the most recent observable inputs for similar instruments in active markets or quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active or are directly or indirectly observable.
(c)
The fair values of the security price guarantees are determined using a modified Black-Scholes model, derived from observable inputs such as US treasury interest rates, our common stock price, and the volatility of our common stock. The valuation model values both the put and call components of the guarantees simultaneously, with the net value of those components representing the fair value of each instrument.
(d)
The fair value of our contingent consideration arrangement is determined based on our evaluation as to the probability and amount of any earn-out that will be achieved based on expected future performance by the acquired entity, as well as our common stock price when the contingent consideration arrangement is payable in shares of our common stock.


77

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





The following table provides a summary of changes in fair value of our Level 3 financial instruments for the years ended September 30, 2013 and 2012 (dollars in thousands):
 
Amount
Balance as of September 30, 2011
$
1,358

Earn-out liability established at time of acquisition
16,444

Payments upon settlement
(2,064
)
Charges to acquisition-related costs, net
1,242

Balance as of September 30, 2012
$
16,980

Earn-out liability established at time of acquisition
450

Payments upon settlement
(17,259
)
Charges to acquisition-related costs, net
279

Balance as of September 30, 2013
$
450


Items Measured at Fair Value on a Nonrecurring Basis
In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011, we performed our annual impairment test for our goodwill and indefinite lived intangible asset. Our indefinite-lived intangible asset is the Dictaphone trade name used in our Healthcare segment which was acquired in March 2006. A change in marketing strategy became effective in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2011 that will result in rebranding a number of our Healthcare offerings, and we will no longer be using the Dictaphone trade name for any new product offerings. This new marketing strategy caused us to update our revenue forecasts used in estimating the fair value of the trade name. Because the Dictaphone trade name will no longer be used for new product offerings, we adjusted the future revenues associated with the Dictaphone trade name in estimating the fair value of the asset. We calculated the fair value of the Dictaphone trade name using a discounted cash flow model based on the adjusted forecast for the existing customer base using the historical products that continue to use the existing trade name designation. In performing our analysis, we used assumptions that we believe a market participant would utilize in valuing the trade name. We determined the fair value of the Dictaphone trade name to be $16.1 million with an estimated remaining useful life of 15 years as of September 30, 2011 and recorded an impairment of $11.7 million ($1.2 million, net of taxes) in restructuring and other charges, net during fiscal 2011.

13.
Restructuring and Other Charges, Net
Fiscal 2013
For fiscal 2013, we recorded net restructuring charges of $17.2 million, which included a $14.6 million severance charge related to the elimination of approximately 300 personnel across multiple functions. In addition to the restructuring charges, we recorded a net gain of $0.8 million related to the sales of two immaterial product lines, which is included in restructuring and other charges, net in our consolidated statements of operations.

Fiscal 2012
For fiscal 2012, we recorded net restructuring charges of $7.5 million, which included a $6.7 million severance charge related to the elimination of approximately 160 personnel across multiple functions primarily to eliminate duplicative positions as a result of businesses acquired.

Fiscal 2011
For fiscal 2011, we recorded net restructuring charges of $23.0 million, which consisted primarily of an $11.7 million impairment charge related to our Dictaphone trade name resulting from a recent change in our Healthcare marketing strategy under which we plan to consolidate our brands and will no longer be using the Dictaphone trade name in our new product offerings. In addition, we recorded a $9.1 million charge related to the elimination of approximately 200 personnel across multiple functions primarily to eliminate duplicative positions as a result of businesses acquired during the year and a $1.9 million charge related to the elimination or consolidation of excess facilities.

78

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





The following table sets forth the fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011 accrual activity relating to restructuring charges (dollars in thousands):
 
Personnel
 
Facilities
 
Other
 
Total
Balance at October 1, 2010
$
1,838

 
$
283

 
$

 
$
2,121

Restructuring charges, net
9,077

 
1,890

 
11,983

 
22,950

Non-cash adjustment
208

 

 
(11,890
)
 
(11,682
)
Cash payments
(6,002
)
 
(1,233
)
 
(93
)
 
(7,328
)
Balance at September 30, 2011
5,121

 
940




6,061

Restructuring charges, net
6,707

 
359

 
400

 
7,466

Cash payments
(10,120
)
 
(1,267
)
 
(400
)
 
(11,787
)
Balance at September 30, 2012
1,708


32




1,740

Restructuring charges, net
15,262

 
1,641

 
304

 
17,207

Non-cash adjustment
(452
)
 

 
(304
)
 
(756
)
Cash payments
(12,288
)
 
(482
)
 

 
(12,770
)
Balance at September 30, 2013
$
4,230


$
1,191


$


$
5,421


Restructuring charges, net by segment are as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
Personnel
 
Facilities
 
Other
 
Total
Fiscal Year 2011
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Healthcare
$
419

 
$

 
$
11,725

 
$
12,144

Mobile and Consumer
5,091

 

 

 
5,091

Enterprise
1,867

 
1,304

 

 
3,171

Imaging
839

 

 

 
839

Corporate
861

 
586

 
258

 
1,705

Total fiscal year 2011
$
9,077

 
$
1,890

 
$
11,983

 
$
22,950

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fiscal Year 2012
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Healthcare
$
443

 
$
61

 
$

 
$
504

Mobile and Consumer
1,679

 
597

 

 
2,276

Enterprise
1,262

 

 

 
1,262

Imaging
184

 

 

 
184

Corporate
3,139

 
(299
)
 
400

 
3,240

Total fiscal year 2012
$
6,707

 
$
359

 
$
400

 
$
7,466

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fiscal Year 2013
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Healthcare
$
1,742

 
$
757

 
$
304

 
$
2,803

Mobile and Consumer
4,124

 
736

 

 
4,860

Enterprise
3,942

 

 

 
3,942

Imaging
1,370

 
55

 

 
1,425

Corporate
4,084

 
93

 

 
4,177

Total fiscal year 2013
$
15,262

 
$
1,641

 
$
304

 
$
17,207

In connection with certain previous acquisitions in 2003 and 2005, we assumed two individually significant lease obligations that were abandoned prior to the acquisition dates. The fair value of the obligations, net of estimated sublease income, was recognized as a liability assumed by us in the allocation of the final purchase price. The net payments were discounted in calculating the fair value, and the discount is being accrued through the term of the lease. Cash payments, net of sublease receipts are presented a

79

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





s cash flows used in financing activities in the consolidated statements of cash flows. At September 30, 2013, the remaining liability related to the lease obligations was $3.5 million. Total expense related to the lease obligations was $(0.1) million and $0.8 million for the years ended September 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively, and is included in Restructuring and other charges, net in our statements of operations.

14.
Supplemental Cash Flow Information
Cash paid for Interest and Income Taxes:
 
Year Ended September 30,
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(Dollars in thousands)
Interest paid
$
95,727

 
$
36,907

 
$
23,034

Income taxes paid
$
18,329

 
$
13,292

 
$
15,949

Non Cash Investing and Financing Activities:
From time to time, we issue shares of our common stock in connection with our business and asset acquisitions, including shares initially held in escrow. In addition, in connection with certain collaboration agreements we have issued shares of our common stock to our partners in satisfaction of our payment obligations under the terms of the agreements, which is discussed in Note 2.

15.
Stockholders' Equity
Stock Repurchases
On April 29, 2013, our Board of Directors approved a share repurchase program for up to $500 million of our outstanding shares of common stock. Approximately $315.6 million remained available for stock repurchases as of September 30, 2013 pursuant to our stock repurchase program. We repurchased 9.8 million shares for $184.4 million during the year ended September 30, 2013. These shares were retired upon repurchase. Under the terms of the repurchase program, we expect to continue to repurchase shares from time to time through a variety of methods, which may include open market purchases, privately negotiated transactions, block trades, accelerated stock repurchase transactions, or any combination of such methods. The timing and the amount of any purchases will be determined by management based on an evaluation of market conditions, capital allocation alternatives, and other factors. The share repurchase program does not require us to acquire any specific number of shares and may be modified, suspended, extended or terminated by us at any time without prior notice.
Stockholders' Rights Plan
On August 19, 2013, the Board of Directors adopted a stockholders' rights plan. Under this plan, the Board of Directors declared a distribution of one right per share of common stock. The rights will become exercisable only following the acquisition by a person or group, without the prior consent of the Board of Directors, of 20% or more of our common stock, or following the announcement of a tender offer or exchange offer to acquire an interest of 20% or more. Each right entitles the holder to purchase one one-thousandth of a share of Series A Preferred Stock, par value $0.001 per share, at an exercise price of $87.00, subject to adjustment. In addition, if the rights become exercisable, the Board may exchange the rights, in whole or in part, for common shares at an exchange ratio of one common share per right. If the rights become exercisable, each right holder will be entitled to purchase, at the exercise price, common stock with a market value equal to twice the exercise price. Should we be acquired, each right would entitle the holder to purchase, at the exercise price, common stock of the acquiring company with a market value equal to twice the exercise price. Any rights owned by the acquiring person or group would become void. The options are redeemable at our option for $0.001 per share at any time before an event that causes the rights to become exercisable. The rights expire on August 19, 2014.

Stock Issuances
During the year ended September 30, 2013, we issued 234,009 shares of our common stock to the Nuance Foundation, an unconsolidated related-party established to provide grants to educational institutions and other non-profit organizations to advance charitable, scientific, literary and educational purposes. For the years ended September 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011, we issued 1,145,783, 1,010,403 and 1,274,513 shares respectively, of our common stock as consideration under our collaboration agreements, which is discussed in Note 2.

80

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





Preferred Stock
We are authorized to issue up to 40,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $0.001 per share. The undesignated shares of preferred stock will have rights, preferences, privileges and restrictions, including voting rights, dividend rights, conversion rights, redemption privileges and liquidation preferences, as shall be determined by the Board of Directors upon issuance of the preferred stock.
Series A Preferred Stock
On August 20, 2013, we eliminated the previous designation of 100,000 shares of the existing Series A Participating Preferred Stock, par value $0.001. No shares of the existing Series A Preferred stock were ever issued or outstanding. On August 20, 2013, we filed a Certificate of Designation of Rights, Preferences and Privileges of Series A Participating Preferred Stock (the "Series A Preferred Stock") with the Secretary of State of Delaware to designate 1,000,000 shares, par value $0.001. The Series A Preferred Stock is entitled to receive dividends equal to the greater of $1.00 and 1,000 times the aggregate per share amount of all dividends declared on our Common Stock. Holders of each share of the Series A Preferred Stock are entitled to 1,000 votes on all matters submitted to a vote of the stockholders of the Corporation, and shall vote as one class. The Series A Preferred Stock is not redeemable, and has the right to certain liquidation preferences over our Common Stock. The Series A Preferred Stock ranks junior to all other series of the Preferred Stock as to the payment of dividends and the distribution of assets.

Series B Preferred Stock
We have designated 15,000,000 shares as Series B Preferred Stock, par value $0.001 per share. In connection with the acquisition of ScanSoft from Xerox Corporation (“Xerox”), we issued 3,562,238 shares of Series B Preferred Stock to Xerox. On March 19, 2004, we announced that Warburg Pincus, a global private equity firm, had agreed to purchase all outstanding shares of our stock held by Xerox Corporation for approximately $80 million, including the 3,562,238 shares of Series B Preferred Stock. The Series B Preferred Stock is convertible into shares of common stock on a one-for-one basis and has a liquidation preference of $1.30 per share plus all declared but unpaid dividends. The holders of Series B Preferred Stock are entitled to non-cumulative dividends at the rate of $0.05 per annum per share, payable when, and if, declared by the Board of Directors. To date, no dividends have been declared by the Board of Directors. Holders of Series B Preferred Stock have no voting rights, except those rights provided under Delaware law. On September 6, 2013, Warburg Pincus converted 3,562,238 shares of Series B Preferred Stock into an equivalent number of common shares. As of September 30, 2013, there are no outstanding shares of Series B Preferred Stock.
Common Stock and Common Stock Warrants
We have, from time to time, entered into stock and warrant agreements with Warburg Pincus. In connection with these agreements, we granted Warburg Pincus the right to request that we use commercially reasonable efforts to register some or all of the shares of common stock issued to them under each of their purchase transactions, including shares of common stock underlying the warrants. The following table summarizes the warrants exercised by Warburg Pincus during the three year period ended September 30, 2013:
Date
 
Exercise Price per Share
 
Warrants Exercised
 
Total Shares Issued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
August 29, 2012
 
$
11.57

 
3,862,422

 
1,998,547

 
February 15, 2012
 
$
20.00

 
3,700,000

 
1,077,744

 
We have determined that all of our common stock warrants should be classified within the stockholders’ equity section of the accompanying consolidated balance sheets based on the conclusion that the above-noted warrants are indexed to our common stock and are exercisable only into our common stock. As of September 30, 2013, there are no outstanding warrants to purchase shares of our common stock.

81

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





16.
Stock-Based Compensation
We recognize stock-based compensation expense over the requisite service period. Our share-based awards are accounted for as equity instruments. The amounts included in the consolidated statements of operations relating to stock-based compensation are as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Cost of product and licensing
$
769

 
$
137

 
$
36

Cost of professional services and hosting
17,924

 
26,409

 
27,814

Cost of maintenance and support
3,537

 
956

 
2,186

Research and development
34,957

 
29,565

 
24,289

Selling and marketing
58,451

 
54,281

 
43,264

General and administrative
43,687

 
63,233

 
49,707

Total
$
159,325

 
$
174,581

 
$
147,296


Stock Options
We have share-based award plans under which employees, officers and directors may be granted stock options to purchase our common stock, generally at fair market value. Our plans do not allow for options to be granted at below fair market value, nor can they be re-priced at any time. Options granted under our plans become exercisable over various periods, typically 2 to 4 years and have a maximum term of 10 years. We have also assumed options and option plans in connection with certain of our acquisitions. These stock options are governed by the plans and agreements that they were originally issued under, but are now exercisable for shares of our common stock.

The table below summarizes activity relating to stock options for the years ended September 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011:
 
Number of
Shares
 
Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
 
Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Term
 
Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value(1)
Outstanding at September 30, 2010
10,703,237

 
$
8.44

 
 
 
 

Granted
1,000,000

 
$
16.44

 
 
 
 

Exercised
(3,866,544
)
 
$
6.23

 
 
 
 

Forfeited
(90,813
)
 
$
12.75

 
 
 
 

Expired
(64,161
)
 
$
15.03

 
 
 
 

Outstanding at September 30, 2011
7,681,719

 
$
10.48

 
 
 
 

Assumed in the acquisition of Vlingo
345,319

 
$
7.57

 
 
 
 

Exercised
(1,803,647
)
 
$
7.40

 
 
 
 

Forfeited
(79,781
)
 
$
8.78

 
 
 
 

Expired
(4,330
)
 
$
8.72

 
 
 
 

Outstanding at September 30, 2012
6,139,280

 
$
11.24

 
 
 
 

Exercised
(1,884,330
)
 
$
7.23

 
 
 
 

Forfeited
(57,290
)
 
$
9.10

 
 
 
 

Expired
(13,502
)
 
$
12.58

 
 
 
 

Outstanding at September 30, 2013
4,184,158

 
$
13.08

 
2.9 years
 
$
23.5
 million
Exercisable at September 30, 2013
4,158,145

 
$
13.08

 
2.9 years
 
$
23.4
 million
Exercisable at September 30, 2012
5,994,586

 
 

 
 
 
 

Exercisable at September 30, 2011
6,565,907

 
 

 
 
 
 

_______________________________________
(1)
The aggregate intrinsic value on this table was calculated based on the positive difference, if any, between the closing market value of our common stock on September 30, 2013 ($18.68) and the exercise price of the underlying options.

82

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)






As of September 30, 2013, the total unamortized fair value of stock options was $0.3 million with a weighted average remaining recognition period of 1.6 years. A summary of weighted-average grant-date (including assumed options) fair value and intrinsic value of stock options exercised is as follows:
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Weighted-average grant-date fair value per share
$

 
$
14.38

 
$
6.13

Total intrinsic value of stock options exercised (in millions)
$
24.9

 
$
30.9

 
$
53.0


We use the Black-Scholes option pricing model to calculate the grant-date fair value of an award. The fair value of the assumed unvested stock options was calculated using a lattice model. There were no stock option grants in fiscal 2013. For fiscal 2012 and 2011, the fair value of the stock options granted and unvested options assumed from acquisitions were calculated using the following weighted-average assumptions:
 
2012
 
2011
Dividend yield
0.0
%
 
0.0
%
Expected volatility
46.6
%
 
46.1
%
Average risk-free interest rate
1.5
%
 
1.2
%
Expected term (in years)
3.5

 
4.1


The dividend yield of zero is based on the fact that we have never paid cash dividends and have no present intention to pay cash dividends. Expected volatility is based on the historical volatility of our common stock over the period commensurate with the expected life of the options and the historical implied volatility from traded options with a term of 180 days or greater. The risk-free interest rate is derived from the average U.S. Treasury STRIPS rate during the period, which approximates the rate in effect at the time of grant, commensurate with the expected life of the instrument. We estimate the expected term of options granted based on historical exercise behavior.
Restricted Awards
We are authorized to issue equity incentive awards in the form of Restricted Awards, including Restricted Units and Restricted Stock, which are individually discussed below. Unvested Restricted Awards may not be sold, transferred or assigned. The fair value of the Restricted Awards is measured based upon the market price of the underlying common stock as of the date of grant, reduced by the purchase price of $0.001 per share of the awards. The Restricted Awards generally are subject to vesting over a period of two to four years, and may have opportunities for acceleration for achievement of defined goals. We also issued certain Restricted Awards with vesting solely dependent on the achievement of specified performance targets. The fair value of the Restricted Awards is amortized to expense over the awards’ applicable requisite service periods using the straight-line method. In the event that the employees’ employment with the Company terminates, or in the case of awards with only performance goals, if those goals are not met, any unvested shares are forfeited and revert to the Company.

83

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





Restricted Units are not included in issued and outstanding common stock until the shares are vested and released. The table below summarizes activity relating to Restricted Units:
 
Number of Shares
Underlying
Restricted Units —
Contingent Awards
 
Number of Shares
Underlying
Restricted Units —
Time-Based
Awards
Outstanding at September 30, 2010
2,867,840

 
7,795,114

Granted
1,779,905

 
5,167,589

Earned/released
(1,312,136
)
 
(4,977,397
)
Forfeited
(380,430
)
 
(699,188
)
Outstanding at September 30, 2011
2,955,179

 
7,286,118

Granted
3,092,062

 
6,341,627

Earned/released
(1,057,207
)
 
(5,474,799
)
Forfeited
(319,754
)
 
(412,334
)
Outstanding at September 30, 2012
4,670,280

 
7,740,612

Granted
3,046,493

 
8,027,067

Earned/released
(1,682,164
)
 
(5,886,568
)
Forfeited
(447,428
)
 
(785,687
)
Outstanding at September 30, 2013
5,587,181

 
9,095,424

Weighted average remaining recognition period of outstanding Restricted Units
1.8 years

 
1.9 years

Unearned stock-based compensation expense of outstanding Restricted Units
$72.0 million
 
$132.6 million
Aggregate intrinsic value of outstanding Restricted Units(1)
$104.4 million
 
$170.0 million
(1)
The aggregate intrinsic value on this table was calculated based on the positive difference between the closing market value of our common stock on September 30, 2013 ($18.68) and the exercise price of the underlying Restricted Units.

A summary of weighted-average grant-date fair value, including those assumed in respective periods, and intrinsic value of all Restricted Units vested is as follows:
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Weighted-average grant-date fair value per share
$
21.51

 
$
25.11

 
$
18.74

Total intrinsic value of shares vested (in millions)
$
158.6

 
$
156.7

 
$
116.0

Restricted Stock is included in the issued and outstanding common stock in these financial statements at the date of grant. There was no restricted stock activity in fiscal 2011. The table below summarizes activity relating to Restricted Stock for fiscal 2013 and 2012:
 
Number of
Shares
Underlying
Restricted Stock
 
Weighted
Average Grant
Date Fair
Value
Outstanding at September 30, 2011

 
$

Granted
750,000

 
$
25.80

Outstanding at September 30, 2012
750,000

 
$
25.80

Granted
750,000

 
$
22.32

Vested
(500,000
)
 
$
24.06

Outstanding at September 30, 2013
1,000,000

 
$
24.06

Weighted average remaining recognition period of outstanding Restricted Stock
1.6 years

 
 
Unearned stock-based compensation expense of outstanding Restricted Stock
$19.2 million
 
 
Aggregate intrinsic value of outstanding Restricted Stock(1)
$18.7 million
 
 

84

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





(1)
The aggregate intrinsic value on this table was calculated based on the positive difference between the closing market value of our common stock on September 30, 2013 ($18.68) and the exercise price of the underlying Restricted Units.

A summary of weighted-average grant-date fair value, including those assumed in respective periods, and intrinsic value of all Restricted Stock vested is as follows:
 
2013
 
2012
Weighted-average grant-date fair value per share
$
22.32

 
$
25.80

Total intrinsic value of shares vested (in millions)
$
10.0

 
$

In order to satisfy our employees’ withholding tax liability as a result of the vesting of Restricted Awards, we have historically repurchased shares upon the employees’ vesting. In fiscal 2013, we withheld payroll taxes totaling $59.7 million relating to 2.9 million shares of common stock that were repurchased or canceled. Based on our estimate of the Restricted Awards that will vest or be released in fiscal 2014, and further assuming that one-third of these Restricted Awards would be repurchased or canceled to satisfy the employee’s withholding tax liability (such amount approximating the tax rate of our employees), we would have an obligation to pay cash relating to approximately 1.8 million shares during fiscal 2014.

1995 Employee Stock Purchase Plan
Our 1995 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (“the Plan”), as amended and restated on January 29, 2010, authorizes the issuance of a maximum of 10,000,000 shares of common stock in semi-annual offerings to employees at a price equal to the lower of 85% of the closing price on the applicable offering commencement date or 85% of the closing price on the applicable offering termination date. Stock-based compensation expense for the employee stock purchase plan is recognized for the fair value benefit accorded to participating employees. At September 30, 2013, we have reserved 1,837,474 shares for future issuance. A summary of the weighted-average grant-date fair value, shares issued and total stock-based compensation expense recognized related to the Plan are as follows:
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Weighted-average grant-date fair value per share
$
4.79

 
$
6.84

 
$
4.63

Total shares issued (in millions)
1.0

 
0.8

 
0.9

Total stock-based compensation expense (in millions)
$
5.1

 
$
4.6

 
$
3.7


The fair value of the purchase rights granted under this plan was estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model that uses the following weighted-average assumptions, which were derived in a manner similar to those discussed above relative to stock options:
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Dividend yield
0.0
%
 
0.0
%
 
0.0
%
Expected volatility
36.9
%
 
42.8
%
 
35.7
%
Average risk-free interest rate
0.1
%
 
0.2
%
 
0.1
%
Expected term (in years)
0.5

 
0.5

 
0.5


17.
Commitments and Contingencies
Operating Leases
We have various operating leases for office space around the world. In connection with many of our acquisitions, we assumed facility lease obligations. Among these assumed obligations are lease payments related to office locations that were vacated by certain of the acquired companies prior to the acquisition date (Note 13). Additionally, certain of our lease obligations have been included in various restructuring charges (Note 13).

85

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





The following table outlines our gross future minimum payments under all non-cancelable operating leases as of September 30, 2013 (dollars in thousands):
Year Ending September 30,
 
Operating Leases
 
Other Contractual Obligations Assumed
 
Total
2014
 
$
41,329

 
$
2,525

 
$
43,854

2015
 
36,751

 
2,529

 
39,280

2016
 
32,086

 
1,048

 
33,134

2017
 
24,626

 

 
24,626

2018
 
16,919

 

 
16,919

Thereafter
 
40,214

 

 
40,214

Total
 
$
191,925

 
$
6,102

 
$
198,027


At September 30, 2013, we have subleased certain office space that is included in the above table to third parties. Total sublease income under contractual terms is $4.6 million and ranges from approximately $0.8 million to $1.9 million on an annual basis through February 2016.

Total rent expense was approximately $34.9 million, $26.4 million and $23.5 million for the years ended September 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

Litigation and Other Claims
Like many companies in the software industry, we have, from time to time, been notified of claims that we may be infringing on, or contributing to the infringement of, the intellectual property rights of others. These claims have been referred to counsel, and they are in various stages of evaluation and negotiation. If it appears necessary or desirable, we may seek licenses for these intellectual property rights. There is no assurance that licenses will be offered by all claimants, that the terms of any offered licenses will be acceptable to us or that in all cases the dispute will be resolved without litigation, which may be time consuming and expensive, and may result in injunctive relief or the payment of damages by us.
We do not believe that the resolution of any such claim or litigation will have a material adverse effect on our financial position and results of operations. However, resolution of any such claim or litigation could require significant management time and adversely impact our operating results, financial position and cash flows.

Guarantees and Other
We include indemnification provisions in the contracts we enter into with customers and business partners. Generally, these provisions require us to defend claims arising out of our products’ infringement of third-party intellectual property rights, breach of contractual obligations and/or unlawful or otherwise culpable conduct. The indemnity obligations generally cover damages, costs and attorneys’ fees arising out of such claims. In most, but not all cases, our total liability under such provisions is limited to either the value of the contract or a specified, agreed upon amount. In some cases our total liability under such provisions is unlimited. In many, but not all, cases, the term of the indemnity provision is perpetual. While the maximum potential amount of future payments we could be required to make under all the indemnification provisions is unlimited, we believe the estimated fair value of these provisions is minimal due to the low frequency with which these provisions have been triggered.

We indemnify our directors and officers to the fullest extent permitted by law. These agreements, among other things, indemnify directors and officers for expenses, judgments, fines, penalties and settlement amounts incurred by such persons in their capacity as a director or officer of the company, regardless of whether the individual is serving in any such capacity at the time the liability or expense is incurred. Additionally, in connection with certain acquisitions we have agreed to indemnify the former officers and members of the boards of directors of those companies, on similar terms as described above, for a period of six years from the acquisition date. In certain cases we purchase director and officer insurance policies related to these obligations, which fully cover the six year periods. To the extent that we do not purchase a director and officer insurance policy for the full period of any contractual indemnification, we would be required to pay for costs incurred, if any, as described above.


86

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





18.
Pension and Other Post-Retirement Benefits

Defined Contribution Plans
We have established a retirement savings plan under Section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code (the “401(k) Plan”). The 401(k) Plan covers substantially all of our U.S. employees who meet minimum age and service requirements, and allows participants to defer a portion of their annual compensation on a pre-tax basis. Effective July 1, 2003, Company match of employee’s contributions was established. We match 50% of employee contributions up to 4% of eligible salary. Employees who were hired prior to April 1, 2004 were 100% vested into the plan as soon as they started to contribute to the plan. Employees hired on or after April 1, 2004, vest one-third of the contribution annually over a three-year period. Our contributions to the 401(k) Plan totaled $6.1 million, $4.6 million and $3.6 million for fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. We make contributions to various other plans in certain of our foreign operations, total contributions to these plans are not material.

Defined Benefit Pension Plans
We sponsor certain defined benefit pension plans that are offered primarily by our foreign subsidiaries. Many of these plans were assumed through our acquisitions or are required by local regulatory requirements. We may deposit funds for these plans with insurance companies, third party trustees, or into government-managed accounts consistent with local regulatory requirements, as applicable. Our total defined benefit plan pension expenses were $1.3 million, $0.1 million and $0.3 million for fiscal 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. The aggregate projected benefit obligation and aggregate net asset (liability) of our defined benefit plans as of September 30, 2013 was $28.1 million and $0.1 million, respectively, and as of September 30, 2012 was $34.2 million and $(3.2) million, respectively. In fiscal 2013, we settled the obligations under our Canadian defined benefit pension plan through a purchase of annuities. The loss on settlement was $1.5 million, and is included in restructuring and other, net.

19.
Income Taxes
The components of (loss) income before income taxes are as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
Year Ended September 30,
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Domestic
$
(208,592
)
 
$
(85,897
)
 
$
10,197

Foreign
111,912

 
151,199

 
19,820

(Loss) income before income taxes
$
(96,680
)
 
$
65,302

 
$
30,017


The components of the provision (benefit) for income taxes are as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
Year Ended September 30,
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Current:
 

 
 

 
 

Federal
$

 
$
(10,967
)
 
$
11,846

State
1,293

 
4,626

 
6,810

Foreign
19,737

 
16,055

 
17,013

 
21,030

 
9,714

 
35,669

Deferred:
 

 
 

 
 

Federal
2,759

 
(131,889
)
 
(37,453
)
State
176

 
(7,317
)
 
(243
)
Foreign
(5,407
)
 
(12,341
)
 
(6,194
)
 
(2,472
)
 
(151,547
)
 
(43,890
)
Provision (benefit) for income taxes
$
18,558

 
$
(141,833
)
 
$
(8,221
)
Effective income tax rate
(19.2
)%
 
(217.2
)%
 
(27.4
)%


87

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





The provision (benefit) for income taxes differed from the amount computed by applying the federal statutory rate to our (loss) income before income taxes as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Federal tax (benefit) provision at statutory rate
$
(33,838
)
 
$
22,856

 
$
10,506

State tax, net of federal benefit
(3,900
)
 
(1,569
)
 
4,182

Foreign tax rate and other foreign related tax items
1,086

 
(42,087
)
 
2,831

Stock-based compensation
8,816

 
11,870

 
6,459

Non-deductible expenditures
1,723

 
5,862

 
10,965

Change in U.S. and foreign valuation allowance
35,958

 
(145,644
)
 
(44,792
)
Executive compensation
3,517

 
4,585

 
3,946

Other
5,196

 
2,294

 
(2,318
)
Provision (benefit) for income taxes
$
18,558

 
$
(141,833
)
 
$
(8,221
)
The effective income tax rate is based upon the income for the year, the composition of the income in different countries, changes relating to valuation allowances for certain countries if and as necessary, and adjustments, if any, for the potential tax consequences, benefits or resolutions of audits or other tax contingencies. Our aggregate income tax rate in foreign jurisdictions is lower than our income tax rate in the United States; substantially all of our income before provision for income taxes from foreign operations has been earned by subsidiaries in Ireland. Our effective tax rate may be adversely affected by earnings being lower than anticipated in countries where we have lower statutory tax rates and higher than anticipated in countries where we have higher statutory tax rates.
Included in the fiscal 2013 provision for income taxes is the establishment of a valuation allowance against our net domestic deferred tax assets. During the third quarter of fiscal 2013, we determined that we had new negative evidence related to our domestic deferred tax asset recoverability assessment. This new evidence, resulting from two consecutive quarterly reductions in our earnings forecast during fiscal 2013, primarily due to the continuing shift toward on-demand and ratable product offerings and revenue streams, led us to establish a valuation allowance against our net domestic deferred tax asset. This valuation allowance was offset by the tax benefits from our current year domestic losses and credits. We also recorded a $10.4 million tax provision representing the establishment of the valuation allowance related to our net domestic deferred tax assets at the beginning of the year.
The effective income tax rate in fiscal 2013 was also impacted by our foreign operations which are subject to a significantly lower tax rate than the U.S. statutory tax rate. This rate differential is driven by our subsidiaries in Ireland. This lower foreign tax rate differential was offset by the impact of the transfer of intangible property between certain of our foreign subsidiaries with significantly different local statutory tax rates. Although the transfer of intangible property between consolidated entities did not result in any gain in the consolidated results of operations, we generated a taxable gain in certain jurisdictions. The future tax deductions associated with the amortization of the transferred intangibles will be generated in a jurisdiction that will not generate an offsetting tax benefit in future periods. The impact of these additional foreign taxes totaled $27.1 million, and is included in the reported foreign tax rate and other foreign related tax items in our effective tax rate reconciliation table above. Excluding the effect of the transfer of intangible property between consolidated entities, the foreign tax rate and other foreign related tax items in the above effective tax rate reconciliation would have been a benefit of $(26.0) million.
Included in fiscal 2012 benefit for income taxes is $145.6 million benefit from releasing the valuation allowance. This includes a net decrease in the valuation allowance of $75.1 million resulting from our acquisitions during fiscal 2012, driven primarily by Transcend and Quantim, for which a net deferred tax liability was recorded in purchase accounting at the time of the acquisitions, resulting in a release of our valuation allowance. This also includes a tax benefit of $70.5 million in connection with the release of the U.S. and certain foreign valuation allowances by the end of fiscal year 2012. The effective income tax rate was also impacted by our foreign operations which are subject to a significantly lower tax rate than the U.S. statutory tax rate. This rate differential is driven by our subsidiaries in Ireland.
Included in fiscal 2011 benefit for income taxes is a decrease in the valuation allowance of $34.7 million related to a tax benefit in connection with the Equitrac acquisition for which a net deferred tax liability was recorded in purchase accounting. Additionally, we have released a $10.6 million valuation allowance associated with a previously acquired intangible asset which has been changed from an indefinite life asset to a finite life asset during fiscal 2011.
The cumulative amount of undistributed earnings of our foreign subsidiaries amounted to $238.0 million at September 30,

88

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





2013. We have not provided any additional federal or state income taxes or foreign withholding taxes on the undistributed earnings; as such earnings have been indefinitely reinvested in the business. Based on our business plan, we expect the cash held overseas will continue to be used for our international operations and therefore do not anticipate repatriating these funds. An estimate of the tax consequences from the repatriation of these earnings is not practicable at this time resulting from the complexities of the utilization of foreign tax credits and other tax assets.
Deferred tax assets (liabilities) consist of the following at September 30, 2013 and 2012 (dollars in thousands):
 
2013
 
2012
Deferred tax assets:
 

 
 

Net operating loss carryforwards
$
252,693

 
$
237,273

Federal and state credit carryforwards
28,201

 
22,840

Capitalized research and development costs
7,706

 
5,347

Accrued expenses and other reserves
58,156

 
55,323

Difference in timing of revenue related items

 
13,888

Deferred compensation
35,333

 
43,078

Other
7,045

 
4,422

Total deferred tax assets
389,134

 
382,171

Valuation allowance for deferred tax assets
(139,676
)
 
(89,404
)
Net deferred tax assets
249,458

 
292,767

Deferred tax liabilities:
 

 
 

Difference in timing of revenue related items
(10,133
)
 

Depreciation
(27,359
)
 
(26,802
)
Convertible debt
(45,607
)
 
(62,012
)
Acquired intangibles
(238,172
)
 
(256,939
)
Net deferred tax liabilities
$
(71,813
)
 
$
(52,986
)
Reported as:
 

 
 

Short-term deferred tax assets
$
74,969

 
$
87,564

Other assets
15,992

 
20,064

Long-term deferred tax liabilities
(162,774
)
 
(160,614
)
Net deferred tax liabilities
$
(71,813
)
 
$
(52,986
)

Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance if, based on the weight of available positive and negative evidence, it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. During fiscal 2013, the valuation allowance for net deferred tax assets increased by $50.3 million. This increase relates to the establishment of valuation allowance against our net domestic deferred tax assets. In the third quarter of fiscal 2013, we concluded that the recoverability of our net domestic deferred tax assets is not more likely than not due to recent negative evidence on our business conditions and trends. As a result, we established a valuation allowance against our net domestic deferred tax assets in the amount of $83.6 million. This increase in domestic valuation allowance was offset by the utilization of foreign deferred tax assets of $33.3 million during the period. As of September 30, 2013, we have $86.5 million and$53.2 million in valuation allowance against our net domestic and foreign deferred tax assets, respectively. As of September 30, 2012, we had no valuation allowance against our U.S. deferred tax assets and we had $89.4 million of valuation allowance against the majority of our international deferred tax assets.
The majority of foreign deferred tax assets relate to net operating losses, the use of which may not be available as a result of limitations on the use of acquired losses. With respect to these foreign losses, there is no assurance that they will be used given the current assessment of the limitations on their use or our current projection of future taxable income in the entities for which these losses relate. Based on our analysis, we have concluded that it is not more likely than not that the majority of our foreign deferred tax assets can be realized and therefore a valuation allowance has been assigned to these deferred tax assets. If we are subsequently able to utilize all or a portion of the foreign deferred tax assets for which a valuation allowance has been established, then we may be required to recognize these deferred tax assets through the reduction of the valuation allowance which could result in a material benefit to our results of operations in the period in which the benefit is determined.


89

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





At September 30, 2013 and 2012, we had U.S. federal net operating loss carryforwards of $763.2 million and $629.3 million, respectively, of which $186.4 million and $181.1 million, respectively, relate to tax deductions from stock-based compensation which will be recorded as additional paid-in-capital when realized. At September 30, 2013 and 2012, we had state net operating loss carryforwards of $246.0 million and $183.1 million, respectively. The net operating loss and credit carryforwards are subject to an annual limitation due to the ownership change limitations provided by the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and similar state tax provisions. At September 30, 2013 and 2012, we had foreign net operating loss carryforwards of $261.1 million and $420.4 million, respectively. These carryforwards will expire at various dates beginning in 2014 and extending through 2031, if not utilized.

At September 30, 2013 and 2012, we had federal research and development carryforwards of $30.9 million and $16.3 million, respectively. At September 30, 2013 and 2012, we had state research and development credit carryforwards of $1.1 million and $4.7 million, respectively.
Uncertain Tax Positions
In accordance with the provisions of ASC 740-10, Income Taxes, we establish reserves for tax uncertainties that reflect the use of the comprehensive model for the recognition and measurement of uncertain tax positions. Under the comprehensive model, reserves are established when we have determined that it is more likely than not that a tax position will or will not be sustained and at the greatest amount for which the result is more likely than not.
The aggregate changes in the balance of our gross unrecognized tax benefits were as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
September 30,
 
2013
 
2012
Balance at beginning of year
$
17,382

 
$
14,935

Increases for tax positions taken during current period
1,586

 
555

Increases for interest and penalty charges
1,170

 
1,127

Increases for acquisitions

 
1,925

Decreases for tax settlements and lapse in statutes
(521
)
 
(1,160
)
Balance at end of year
$
19,617

 
$
17,382


As of September 30, 2013, $19.6 million of the unrecognized tax benefits, if recognized, would impact our effective tax rate. We do not expect a significant change in the amount of unrecognized tax benefits within the next 12 months. We recognized interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions in our provision for income taxes and had accrued $4.6 million of such interest and penalties as of September 30, 2013.

We are subject to U.S. federal income tax, various state and local taxes, and international income taxes in numerous jurisdictions. The federal, state and foreign tax returns are generally subject to tax examinations for the tax years ended in 2009 through 2013.

20.
Segment and Geographic Information and Significant Customers
We follow the provisions of ASC 280, Segment Reporting, which established standards for reporting information about operating segments. ASC 280 also established standards for disclosures about products, services and geographic areas. Operating segments are defined as components of an enterprise for which separate financial information is available and evaluated regularly by the chief operating decision maker in deciding how to allocate resources and in assessing performance. Our chief operating decision maker (“CODM”) is the Chief Executive Officer of the Company.

We have identified four reportable segments as defined by ASC 280-50-1 based on the level of financial information regularly reviewed by the CODM in allocating resources and assessing performance of each segment; Healthcare, Mobile and Consumer, Enterprise and Imaging.

The Healthcare segment is primarily engaged in voice and language processing for healthcare information management offered both by licensing and on-demand. The Mobile and Consumer segment is primarily engaged in sales of voice and language solutions that are embedded in a device (such as a cell phone, car or tablet computer) or installed on a personal computer. Our Enterprise segment offers voice and language solutions by licensing as well as on-demand solutions hosted by us that are designed

90

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





to help companies better support, understand and communicate with their customers. The Imaging segment sells document capture and print management solutions that are embedded in copiers and multi-function printers as well as packaged software for document management.

Segment profit is an important measure used for evaluating performance and for decision-making purposes. Segment profit reflects the direct controllable costs of each segment together with an allocation of sales and corporate marketing expenses, and certain research and development project costs that benefit multiple product offerings. Segment profit represents income from operations excluding stock-based compensation, amortization of intangible assets, acquisition-related costs, net, restructuring and other charges, net, costs associated with intellectual property collaboration agreements, other income (expense), net and certain unallocated corporate expenses. We believe that these adjustments allow for more complete comparisons to the financial results of the historical operations.
We do not track our assets by operating segment. Consequently, it is not practical to show assets by operating segment nor depreciation by operating segment. The following table presents segment results along with a reconciliation of segment profit to (loss) income before income taxes (dollars in thousands):
 
Year Ended September 30,
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Segment revenues(a):
 

 
 

 
 

Healthcare
$
911,611

 
$
669,354

 
$
526,804

Mobile and Consumer
479,195

 
508,256

 
393,343

Enterprise
323,452

 
332,034

 
296,373

Imaging
243,372

 
228,421

 
177,418

Total segment revenues
1,957,630

 
1,738,065

 
1,393,938

Acquisition related revenue adjustments
(102,351
)
 
(86,556
)
 
(75,197
)
Total consolidated revenue
1,855,279

 
1,651,509

 
1,318,741

Segment profit:
 

 
 

 
 

Healthcare
352,157

 
314,862

 
269,357

Mobile and Consumer
142,998

 
227,641

 
170,918

Enterprise
78,937

 
90,846

 
63,276

Imaging
98,187

 
91,585

 
69,116

Total segment profit
672,279

 
724,934

 
572,667

Corporate expenses and other, net
(135,300
)
 
(102,847
)
 
(100,288
)
Acquisition-related revenues and costs of revenue adjustment
(93,679
)
 
(77,856
)
 
(64,724
)
Non-cash stock-based compensation
(159,325
)
 
(174,581
)
 
(147,296
)
Amortization of intangible assets
(168,841
)
 
(155,450
)
 
(143,330
)
Acquisition-related costs, net
(29,685
)
 
(58,746
)
 
(21,866
)
Restructuring and other charges, net
(16,385
)
 
(8,268
)
 
(22,862
)
Costs associated with IP collaboration agreements
(20,582
)
 
(21,000
)
 
(19,750
)
Other expense, net
(145,162
)
 
(60,884
)
 
(22,534
)
(Loss) income before income taxes
$
(96,680
)
 
$
65,302

 
$
30,017


(a)
Segment revenues differ from reported revenues due to certain revenue adjustments related to acquisitions that would otherwise have been recognized but for the purchase accounting treatment of the business combinations. Segment revenues also include revenue that the business would have otherwise recognized had we not acquired intellectual property and other assets from the same customer. These revenues are included to allow for more complete comparisons to the financial results of historical operations and in evaluating management performance.


91

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





No country outside of the United States provided greater than 10% of our total revenue. Revenue, classified by the major geographic areas in which our customers are located, was as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
United States
$
1,339,733

 
$
1,175,158

 
$
963,688

International
515,546

 
476,351

 
355,053

Total
$
1,855,279

 
$
1,651,509

 
$
1,318,741


No country outside of the United States held greater than 10% of our long-lived or total assets. Our long-lived assets, including intangible assets and goodwill, were located as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
September 30,
2013
 
September 30,
2012
United States
$
3,718,009

 
$
3,161,995

International
957,059

 
935,739

Total
$
4,675,068

 
$
4,097,734


21.
Quarterly Data (Unaudited)
The following information has been derived from unaudited consolidated financial statements that, in the opinion of management, include all recurring adjustments necessary for a fair statement of such information (dollars in thousands, except per share amounts):
 
First
Quarter
 
Second
Quarter
 
Third
Quarter
 
Fourth
Quarter
 
Year
2013
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Total revenue
$
462,268

 
$
450,999

 
$
469,769

 
$
472,243

 
$
1,855,279

Gross profit
$
279,696

 
$
259,814

 
$
275,711

 
$
273,508

 
$
1,088,729

Net loss
$
(22,096
)
 
$
(25,848
)
 
$
(34,974
)
 
$
(32,320
)
 
$
(115,238
)
Net loss per share:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
$
(0.07
)
 
$
(0.08
)
 
$
(0.11
)
 
$
(0.10
)
 
$
(0.37
)
Diluted
$
(0.07
)
 
$
(0.08
)
 
$
(0.11
)
 
$
(0.10
)
 
$
(0.37
)
Weighted average common shares outstanding:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
312,571

 
315,473

 
315,441

 
310,944

 
313,587

Diluted
312,571

 
315,473

 
315,441

 
310,944

 
313,587



92

Table of Contents
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)





 
First
Quarter
 
Second
Quarter
 
Third
Quarter
 
Fourth
Quarter
 
Year
2012
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Total revenue
$
360,643

 
$
390,341

 
$
431,744

 
$
468,781

 
$
1,651,509

Gross profit
$
225,771

 
$
249,669

 
$
273,844

 
$
297,296

 
$
1,046,580

Net income
$
9,340

 
$
890

 
$
79,264

 
$
117,641

 
$
207,135

Net income per share:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
$
0.03

 
$
0.00

 
$
0.26

 
$
0.38

 
$
0.67

Diluted
$
0.03

 
$
0.00

 
$
0.25

 
$
0.36

 
$
0.65

Weighted average common shares outstanding:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
304,011

 
305,282

 
306,766

 
309,307

 
306,371

Diluted
320,536

 
322,642

 
320,559

 
322,424

 
320,822


In the quarter ended September 30, 2012, we recorded a tax benefit of $97.1 million which included $70.5 million in connection with the release of the U.S. and certain foreign valuation allowances as well as $26.6 million in connection with the establishment of a net deferred tax liability in purchase accounting related to our acquisition of Quantim. See Note 19 for additional discussion.


93

Table of Contents

Item 9.
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

Not applicable.

Item 9A.
Controls and Procedures

Disclosure Controls and Procedures
Our management, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, has evaluated the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures. Our disclosure controls and procedures are designed (i) to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed and summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms and (ii) to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the reports we file or submit under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. Based on that evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that, as of September 30, 2013, our disclosure controls and procedures were effective.

Management Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. Our internal control over financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Our internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that:

pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of our assets;
provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that our receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of our management and directors; and,
provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of our assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions and that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Management has assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2013, utilizing the criteria set forth in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”). The internal controls over financial reporting for certain of our acquisitions completed during fiscal 2013 were excluded from management's assessment. These excluded acquisitions constituted approximately 0.3% of our consolidated assets as of September 30, 2013 and approximately 4.7% of our consolidated revenues for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2013 The most significant of these acquisitions was Accentus, Inc., which we acquired on November 19, 2012, and constituted approximately 0.3% of our consolidated assets and approximately 2.6% of our consolidated revenues. Based on the results of this assessment, management (including our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer) has concluded that, as of September 30, 2013, our internal control over financial reporting was effective.
The attestation report concerning the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2013 issued by BDO USA, LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, appears in Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Changes in Internal Controls Over Financial Reporting
There have been no changes in our internal controls over financial reporting during the fourth quarter of fiscal 2013 that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal controls over financial reporting.

Item 9B.
Other Information
None.


94

Table of Contents

PART III

Certain information required by Part III is omitted from this Annual Report on Form 10-K since we intend to file our definitive Proxy Statement for our next Annual Meeting of Stockholders, pursuant to Regulation 14A of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Proxy Statement”), within 120 days of the end of the fiscal year covered by this report, and certain information to be included in the Proxy Statement is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 10.
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

The information required by this item concerning our directors is incorporated by reference to the information set forth in the section titled “Election of Directors” in our Proxy Statement. Information required by this item concerning our executive officers is incorporated by reference to the information set forth in the section entitled “Executive Compensation, Management and Other Information” in our Proxy Statement. Information regarding Section 16 reporting compliance is incorporated by reference to the information set forth in the section entitled “Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” in our Proxy Statement.

Our Board of Directors adopted a Code of Business Conduct and Ethics for all of our directors, officers and employees on February 24, 2004. Our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics can be found at our website: www.nuance.com. We will provide to any person without charge, upon request, a copy of our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics. Such a request should be made in writing and addressed to Investor Relations, Nuance Communications, Inc., 1 Wayside Road, Burlington, MA 01803.

To date, there have been no waivers under our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics. We will post any waivers, if and when granted, of our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics on our website at www.nuance.com.

Item 11.
Executive Compensation

The information required by this item regarding executive compensation is incorporated by reference to the information set forth in the section titled “Executive Compensation, Management and Other Information” in our Proxy Statement.

Item 12.
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholders Matters

The information required by this item regarding security ownership of certain beneficial owners and management is incorporated by reference to the information set forth in the sections titled “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management” and “Equity Compensation Plan Information” in our Proxy Statement.

Item 13.
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

It is the policy of the Board that all transactions required to be reported pursuant to Item 404 of Regulation S-K be subject to approval by the Audit Committee of the Board. In furtherance of relevant NASDAQ rules and our commitment to corporate governance, the charter of the Audit Committee provides that the Audit Committee shall review and approve any proposed related party transactions including, transactions required to be reported pursuant to Item 404 of Regulation S-K for potential conflict of interest situations. The Audit Committee reviews the material facts of all transactions that require the committee’s approval and either approves or disapproves of the transaction. In determining whether to approve a transaction, the Audit Committee will take into account, among other factors it deems appropriate, whether the transaction is on terms no less favorable than terms generally available to an unaffiliated third-party under the same or similar circumstances.

The additional information required by this item regarding certain relationships and related party transactions is incorporated by reference to the information set forth in the sections titled “Transactions with Related Persons” and “Corporate Governance-Board Independence” in our Proxy Statement.

Item 14.
Principal Accountant Fees and Services

The information required by this section is incorporated by reference from the information in the section entitled “Ratification of Appointment of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” in our Proxy Statement.



95

Table of Contents

PART IV

Item 15.
Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

(a)
The following documents are filed as a part of this Report:
(1)
Financial Statements — See Index to Financial Statements in Item 8 of this Report.
(2)
Financial Statement Schedules — All schedules have been omitted as the requested information is inapplicable or the information is presented in the financial statements or related notes included as part of this Report.
(3)
Exhibits — See Item 15(b) of this Report below.
(b)
Exhibits.

96

Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this Annual Report on Form 10-K to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
NUANCE COMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 
 
 
 
By: 
/s/  Paul A. Ricci
 
 
Paul A. Ricci
 
 
Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this Annual Report on Form 10-K has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
POWER OF ATTORNEY
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        
KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that each individual whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Paul A. Ricci and Thomas L. Beaudoin, and each of them acting individually, as his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, each with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him or her and in his or her name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments to this Annual Report on Form 10-K and to file the same with all exhibits thereto, and all documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done, as fully to all intents and purposes as he or she might or could do in person, and hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents or any of them, or their or his substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof. This power of attorney may be executed in counterparts.

 
 
/s/  Paul A. Ricci
Date: November 27, 2013
 
Paul A. Ricci, Chief Executive Officer and
Chairman of the Board
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
/s/  Thomas L. Beaudoin
Date: November 27, 2013
 
Thomas L. Beaudoin, Executive Vice President and
Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
/s/  Daniel D. Tempesta
Date: November 27, 2013
 
Daniel D. Tempesta, Chief Accounting Officer and
Corporate Controller
(Principal Accounting Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
/s/  Robert J. Frankenberg
Date: November 27, 2013
 
Robert J. Frankenberg, Director
 
 
 
 
 
/s/  Patrick T. Hackett
Date: November 27, 2013
 
Patrick T. Hackett, Director
 
 
 



Table of Contents

 
 
/s/  Brett Icahn
Date: November 27, 2013
 
Brett Icahn, Director
 
 
 
 
 
/s/  William H. Janeway
Date: November 27, 2013
 
William H. Janeway, Director
 
 
 
 
 
/s/  Mark R. Laret
Date: November 27, 2013
 
Mark R. Laret, Director
 
 
 
 
 
/s/  Katharine A. Martin
Date: November 27, 2013
 
Katharine A. Martin, Director
 
 
 
 
 
/s/  Mark Myers
Date: November 27, 2013
 
Mark Myers, Director
 
 
 
 
 
/s/  Philip Quigley
Date: November 27, 2013
 
Philip Quigley, Director
 
 
 
 
 
/s/  David Schechter
Date: November 27, 2013
 
David Schechter, Director
 
 
 
 
 
/s/  Robert G. Teresi
Date: November 27, 2013
 
Robert G. Teresi, Director



Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX

 
 
 
 
Incorporated by Reference
Exhibit Index
 
Exhibit Description
 
Form
 
File No.
 
Exhibit
 
Filing Date
 
Filed Herewith
2.1

 
Agreement for the acquisition of the entire issued share capital of SpinVox Limited, the substitution of Foxtrot Acquisition Limited as the issuer of a debt instrument issued by SpinVox Limited, and the release and cancellation of such debt instrument in consideration of shares in Foxtrot Acquisition Limited dated December 29, 2009
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
2.1
 
1/5/2010
 
 
2.2

 
Agreement for the acquisition of shares in Foxtrot Acquisition Limited and the payment of certain sums to the Mezzanine Lenders and other parties dated December 29, 2009
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
2.2
 
1/5/2010
 
 
2.3

 
Share Purchase Agreement, dated as of June 6, 2011, by and among Nuance, Ruetli Holding Corporation, the shareholders of SVOX and smac partners GmbH, as the shareholder representative.
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
2.1
 
8/9/2011
 
 
2.4

 
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of May 10, 2011, by and among Nuance, Ellipse Acquisition Corporation, Equitrac Corporation, U.S. Bank National Association, as escrow agent, and Cornerstone Equity Investors, LLC, as the stockholder representative.
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
2.2
 
8/9/2011
 
 
2.5

 
Agreement and Plan of Merger dated as of October 6, 2011, by and among Nuance Communications, Inc., Sonic Acquisition Corporation, Swype, Inc., and Adrian Smith, as shareholder representative.
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
2.1
 
10/7/2011
 
 
2.6

 
Agreement and Plan of Merger among Nuance Communications, Inc., Vertigo Acquisition Corporation, Vlingo Corporation, U.S. Bank National Association, as Escrow Agent, and Stockholder Representative, dated December 16, 2011
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
2.1
 
6/7/2012
 
 
2.7

 
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of March 6, 2012, by and among Nuance Communications, Inc., Townsend Merger Corporation and Transcend Services, Inc.
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
2.1
 
4/27/2012
 
 
2.8

 
Stock Purchase Agreement by and among Nuance, J.A. Thomas and Associates, Inc., the shareholders of J.A. Thomas and Associates and Donald Leeper, as the shareholder representative, dated October 1, 2012
 
8-K
 
0-27038

 
2.1
 
12/17/2012

 
 
2.9

 
Asset Purchase Agreement, dated as of May 24, 2013, by and among Nuance, Telluride, Inc., Tweddle Group, Inc., Tweddle Group Technologies, LLC, The Andrew M. Tweddle Revocable Living Trust and Andrew M. Tweddle
 
8-K
 
0-27038

 
2.1
 
6/5/2013

 
 
3.1

 
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Registrant.
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
3.2
 
5/11/2001
 
 
3.2

 
Certificate of Amendment of the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Registrant.
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
3.1
 
8/9/2004
 
 
3.3

 
Certificate of Ownership and Merger.
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
3.1
 
10/19/2005
 
 
3.4

 
Amended and Restated Bylaws of the Registrant.
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
3.1
 
11/13/2007
 
 
3.5

 
Certificate of Amendment of the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Registrant, as amended.
 
S-3
 
333-142182
 
3.3
 
4/18/2007
 
 
3.6

 
Certificate of Elimination of the Series A Participating Preferred Stock
 
8-K
 
0-27038

 
3.1
 
8/20/2013
 
 
3.7

 
Certificate of Designation of Rights, Preferences and Privileges of Series A Participating Preferred Stock
 
8-K
 
0-27038

 
3.2
 
8/20/2013

 
 


Table of Contents

 
 
 
 
Incorporated by Reference
Exhibit Index
 
Exhibit Description
 
Form
 
File No.
 
Exhibit
 
Filing Date
 
Filed Herewith
4.1

 
Specimen Common Stock Certificate.
 
8-A
 
0-27038
 
4.1
 
12/6/1995
 
 
4.2

 
Indenture, dated as of August 13, 2007, between Nuance Communications, Inc. and U.S. Bank National Association, as Trustee (including form of 2.75% Convertible Subordinated Debentures due 2027).
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
4.1
 
8/17/2007
 
 
4.3

 
Third Amended and Restated Stockholders Agreement, dated as of January 29, 2009, by and among Nuance Communications, Inc., Warburg Pincus Private Equity VIII, L.P., Warburg Pincus Netherlands Private Equity VIII C.V. I, and WP-WPVIII Investors, L.P., Warburg Pincus Private Equity X, L.P. and Warburg Pincus X Partners, L.P. 
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
4.1
 
2/9/2009
 
 
4.4

 
Indenture, dated as of October 24, 2011, by and between Nuance Communications, Inc. and U.S. Bank National Association
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
4.1
 
10/24/2011
 
 
4.5

 
Indenture, dated August 14, 2012, among Nuance Communications, Inc., the guarantors party thereto and U.S. Bank National Association, relating to the 5.375% Senior Notes due 2020.
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
4.1
 
8/14/2012
 
 
4.6

 
Preferred Shares Rights Agreement, dated as of August 19, 2013, by and between Nuance Communications, Inc. and American Stock Transfer & Trust Company, LLC, as rights agent
 
8-K
 
0-27038

 
4.1
 
8/20/2013

 
 
10.1

 
Form of Indemnification Agreement.
 
S-8
 
333-108767
 
10.1
 
9/12/2003
 
 
10.2

 
Stand Alone Stock Option Agreement Number 1, dated as of August 21, 2000, by and between the Registrant and Paul A. Ricci.*
 
S-8
 
333-49656
 
4.3
 
11/9/2000
 
 
10.3

 
Caere Corporation 1992 Non-Employee Directors’ Stock Option Plan.*
 
S-8
 
333-33464
 
10.4
 
3/29/2000
 
 
10.4

 
1993 Incentive Stock Option Plan, as amended.*
 
S-1
 
333-100647
 
10.17
 
10/21/2002
 
 
10.5

 
1995 Employee Stock Purchase Plan, as amended and restated on December 1, 2009.*
 
14A
 
0-27038
 
Annex B
 
12/18/2009
 
 
10.6

 
Amended and Restated 1995 Directors’ Stock Option Plan, as amended.*
 
14A
 
0-27038
 
Annex B
 
12/8/2010
 
 
10.7

 
1997 Employee Stock Option Plan, as amended.*
 
S-1
 
333-100647
 
10.19
 
10/21/2002
 
 
10.8

 
1998 Stock Option Plan.*
 
S-8
 
333-74343
 
99.1
 
3/12/1999
 
 
10.9

 
Amended and Restated Stock Plan.*
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
99.1
 
2/5/2009
 
 
10.10

 
2000 NonStatutory Stock Option Plan, as amended.*
 
S-8
 
333-108767
 
4.1
 
9/12/2003
 
 
10.11

 
ScanSoft 2003 Stock Plan.*
 
S-8
 
333-108767
 
4.3
 
9/12/2003
 
 
10.12

 
Nuance Communications, Inc. 2001 Nonstatutory Stock Option Plan.*
 
S-8
 
333-128396
 
4.1
 
9/16/2005
 
 
10.13

 
Nuance Communications, Inc. 2000 Stock Plan.*
 
S-8
 
333-128396
 
4.2
 
9/16/2005
 
 
10.14

 
Nuance Communications, Inc. 1998 Stock Plan.*
 
S-8
 
333-128396
 
4.3
 
9/16/2005
 
 
10.15

 
Nuance Communications, Inc. 1994 Flexible Stock Incentive Plan.*
 
S-8
 
333-128396
 
4.4
 
9/16/2005
 
 
10.16

 
Mobeus Corporation 2006 Share Incentive Plan*
 
S-8
 
0-23038
 
4.1
 
6/29/2012
 
 
10.17

 
Form of Restricted Stock Purchase Agreement.*
 
10-K/A
 
0-27038
 
10.17
 
12/15/2006
 
 
10.18

 
Form of Restricted Stock Unit Purchase Agreement.*
 
10-K/A
 
0-27038
 
10.18
 
12/15/2006
 
 
10.19

 
Form of Stock Option Agreement.*
 
10-K/A
 
0-27038
 
10.19
 
12/15/2006
 
 


Table of Contents

 
 
 
 
Incorporated by Reference
Exhibit Index
 
Exhibit Description
 
Form
 
File No.
 
Exhibit
 
Filing Date
 
Filed Herewith
10.20

 
2005 Severance Benefit Plan for Executive Officers.*
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
10.1
 
5/10/2005
 
 
10.21

 
Officer Short-term Disability Plan.*
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
10.2
 
5/10/2005
 
 
10.22

 
Letter, dated May 23, 2004, from the Registrant to Steven Chambers regarding certain employment matters.*
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
10.2
 
8/9/2004
 
 
10.23

 
Increase Joinder, dated as of August 24, 2007, by and among Nuance Communications, Inc. and the other parties identified therein, to the Amended and Restated Senior Secured Credit Facility dated as of April 5, 2007.
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
10.1
 
8/30/2007
 
 
10.24

 
Letter, dated June 3, 2008, from the Registrant to Thomas L. Beaudoin regarding certain employment matters.
 
10-K
 
0-27038
 
10.39
 
12/1/2008
 
 
10.25

 
Amended and Restated Employment Agreement, dated as of June 23, 2009, by and between Nuance Communications, Inc. and Paul Ricci.*
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
99.1
 
6/26/2009
 
 
10.26

 
Letter, dated March 29, 2010, to Janet Dillione regarding certain employment matters.*
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
10.1
 
8/9/2010
 
 
10.27

 
Letter, dated September 9, 2010, to Bruce Bowden regarding certain employment matters.*
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
10.1
 
2/9/2011
 
 
10.28

 
Amendment Agreement, dated as of July 7, 2011, among Nuance Communications, the Lenders party thereto, UBS AG, Stamford Branch, as administrative agent and as collateral agent, Citigroup Global Markets Inc. as sole lead arranger and sole book runner and the other parties thereto from time to time to the Credit Agreement.
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
10.1
 
7/7/2011
 
 
10.29

 
Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of July 7, 2011 among Nuance, UBS AG, Stamford Branch, as administrative agent, Citicorp North America, Inc., as syndication agent, Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, as documentation agent, Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and UBS Securities LLC, as joint lead arrangers, Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC and Banc Of America Securities LLC as co-arrangers, and Citigroup Global Markets Inc., UBS Securities LLC and Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC as joint bookrunners.
 
10-Q
 
02-7308
 
10.2
 
7/7/2011
 
 
10.30

 
Letter dated March 14, 2011 to Bill Nelson regarding certain employment matters.*
 
10-Q
 
02-7308
 
10.1
 
8/9/2011
 
 
10.31

 
Purchase Agreement, dated as of October 18, 2011, by and between Nuance Communications, Inc. and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC, as representative of the initial purchasers named therein.
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
10.1
 
10/24/2011
 
 
10.32

 
Employment Agreement dated November 11, 2011 between the Registrant and Paul Ricci.*
 
10-Q
 
0-27038
 
10.2
 
2/9/2012
 
 
10.33

 
Purchase Agreement, dated August 9, 2012, by and among Nuance Communications, Inc., the guarantors party thereto and Barclays Capital Inc.
 
8-K
 
02-7038
 
10.1
 
8/14/2012
 
 
10.34

 
Purchase Agreement dated October 15, 2012, by and among Nuance Communications, Inc., the guarantors party thereto and Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC
 
8-K
 
0-27038

 
10.1
 
10/16/2012

 
 
10.35

 
Amended and Restated 2000 Stock Plan*
 
S-8
 
333-128396
 
4.1
 
5/7/2013
 
 
10.36

 
Amendment Agreement
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
10.1
 
8/12/2013
 
 
10.37

 
Amended and Restated Credit Agreement
 
8-K
 
0-27038
 
10.2
 
8/12/2013
 
 


Table of Contents

 
 
 
 
Incorporated by Reference
Exhibit Index
 
Exhibit Description
 
Form
 
File No.
 
Exhibit
 
Filing Date
 
Filed Herewith
10.38

 
Nomination and Standstill Agreement Dated October 7, 2013 by and between Nuance Communications, Inc., High River Limited Partnership, Hopper Investments LLC, Barberry Corp., Icahn Partners LP, Icahn Partners Master Fund LP, Icahn Partners Master Fund II LP, Icahn Partners Master Fund III LP, Icahn Enterprises G.P. Inc., Icahn Enterprises Holdings L.P., IPH GP LLC, Icahn Capital LP, Icahn Onshore LP, Icahn Offshore LP, and Beckton Corp.
 
8-K
 
001-36056
 
99.1
 
10/8/2013

 
 
14.1

 
Registrant’s Code of Business Conduct and Ethics.
 
10-K
 
0-27038
 
14.1
 
3/15/2004
 
 
21.1

 
Subsidiaries of the Registrant.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
X
23.1

 
Consent of BDO USA, LLP.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
X
24.1

 
Power of Attorney. (See Signature Page).
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
X
31.1

 
Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or 15d-14(a).
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
X
31.2

 
Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or 15d-14(a).
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
X
32.1

 
Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
X
101

 
The following materials from Nuance Communications, Inc.’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2013, formatted in XBRL (Extensible Business Reporting Language): (i) the Consolidated Statements of Operations, (ii) the Consolidated Balance Sheets, (iii) the Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity and Comprehensive Loss, (iv) the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, and (v) Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
X

*
 
Denotes management compensatory plan or arrangement